blob: ed1ddc2648426d66c464ad1e9745cdb78b479945 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufee48ce2012-11-26 03:11:05 +01007 2012/11/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100482 - tune.zlib.memlevel
483 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200485 * Debugging
486 - debug
487 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488
489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004903.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491------------------------------------
492
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493ca-base <dir>
494 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200495 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
496 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498chroot <jail dir>
499 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
500 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
501 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
502 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
503 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
504 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100505
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100506cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
507 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
508 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
509 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
510 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
511 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
512 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
513 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
514 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
515 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
516 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
517 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
518 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
519 they overlap.
520
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521crt-base <dir>
522 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
523 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
524 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526daemon
527 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
528 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
529 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
530
531gid <number>
532 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
533 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
534 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
535 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537group <group name>
538 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
539 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200541log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
543 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100544 configured with "log global".
545
546 <address> can be one of:
547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100548 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100549 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
550 port).
551
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100552 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
553 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
554 port).
555
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100556 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
557 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
558 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
559 writeable).
560
561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562
563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
566
567 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200568 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
569 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
570 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
571 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
572 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
573 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200575 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100577log-send-hostname [<string>]
578 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
579 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
580 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
581 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
582 the logs.
583
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000584log-tag <string>
585 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
586 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
587 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
588 running on the same host.
589
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590nbproc <number>
591 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
592 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
593 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
594 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
595 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
596
597pidfile <pidfile>
598 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
599 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
600 starting the process. See also "daemon".
601
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100602stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200603 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
604 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
605 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
606 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
607 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
608 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
609 the number of processes used.
610
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200611stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
612 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
613 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
614 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
615 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200616
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200617 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
618 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
619 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620
621stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
622 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
623 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100624 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625
626stats maxconn <connections>
627 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
628 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630uid <number>
631 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
632 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
633 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
634 one. See also "gid" and "user".
635
636ulimit-n <number>
637 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
638 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
639 option.
640
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100641unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
642 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
643
644 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
645 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
646 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
647 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
648 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
649 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
650 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
651 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
652 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
653 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655user <user name>
656 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
657 See also "uid" and "group".
658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200659node <name>
660 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
661
662 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
663 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
664 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
665 traffic.
666
667description <text>
668 Add a text that describes the instance.
669
670 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
671 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
672 "<" and ">" characters.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006753.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676-----------------------
677
678maxconn <number>
679 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
680 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
681 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
682 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
683
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200684maxconnrate <number>
685 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
686 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
687 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
688 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
689 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
690 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
691 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
692 fairness.
693
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100694maxcomprate <number>
695 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
696 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
697 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
698 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
699 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
700 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
701 default value.
702
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100703maxcompcpuusage <number>
704 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
705 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
706 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
707 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
708 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
709 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
710 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
711 process down and from introducing high latencies.
712
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100713maxpipes <number>
714 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
715 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
716 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
717 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
718 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
719 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
720
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200721maxsslconn <number>
722 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
723 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
724 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
725 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
726 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
727 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
728 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
729
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100730maxzlibmem <number>
731 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
732 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
733 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100734 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
735 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
736 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738noepoll
739 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
740 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100741 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
743nokqueue
744 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
745 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
746 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
747
748nopoll
749 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
750 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100751 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100752 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100754nosplice
755 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
756 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
757 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100758 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100759 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
760 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
761 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
762 "option splice-response".
763
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200764spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
765 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
766 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
767 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
768 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
769 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
770
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200771tune.bufsize <number>
772 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
773 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
774 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
775 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
776 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
777 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
778 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
779 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400780 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
781 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
782 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200783
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200784tune.chksize <number>
785 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
786 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
787 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
788 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
789 checks whenever possible.
790
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100791tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
792 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
793 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
794 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
795 this value. The default value is 1.
796
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100797tune.http.cookielen <number>
798 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
799 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
800 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
801 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
802 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
803 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
804 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
805 to change this value.
806
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200807tune.http.maxhdr <number>
808 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
809 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
810 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
811 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
812 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
813 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
814 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
815 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
816 limit too high.
817
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100818tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100819 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
820 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
821 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
822 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
823 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
824 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
825 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
826 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
827 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
828 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100829
830tune.maxpollevents <number>
831 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
832 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
833 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
834 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
835 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
836
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200837tune.maxrewrite <number>
838 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
839 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
840 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
841 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
842 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
843 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
844 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
845 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
846 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
847 bufsize.
848
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200849tune.pipesize <number>
850 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
851 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
852 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
853 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
854 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
855 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
856
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100857tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
858tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
859 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
860 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
861 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
862 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
863 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
864 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
865 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
866
867tune.sndbuf.client <number>
868tune.sndbuf.server <number>
869 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
870 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
871 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
872 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
873 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
874 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
875 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
876 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
877 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
878 notifying haproxy again.
879
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100880tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
881 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in number of sessions. Each
882 entry uses approximately 600 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced
883 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
884 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
885 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
886 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-
887 allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is
888 greater than 1.
889
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100890tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
891 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
892 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
893 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
894 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
895 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
896 being used for too long.
897
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100898tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
899 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
900 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
901 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
902 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
903 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
904
905tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
906 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
907 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
908 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
909 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009113.3. Debugging
912--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914debug
915 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
916 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
917 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
918 system startup.
919
920quiet
921 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
922 line argument "-q".
923
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009253.4. Userlists
926--------------
927It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
928http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
929it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
930
931userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100932 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100933 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
934
935group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100936 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100937 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
938 proceeded by "users" keyword.
939
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100940user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
941 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100942 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
943 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100944 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
945 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100946 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
947 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
948
949
950 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100951 userlist L1
952 group G1 users tiger,scott
953 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100954
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100955 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
956 user scott insecure-password elgato
957 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100958
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100959 userlist L2
960 group G1
961 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100962
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100963 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
964 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
965 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100966
967 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200968
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200969
9703.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200971----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200972It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
973haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
974pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
975identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
976or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
977Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
978known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
979the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
980process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
981during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
982tables.
983
984peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400985 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200986 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
987
988peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
989 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
990 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
991 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
992 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
993 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
994 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
995
996 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
997 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
998
999 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1000 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1001 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1002 across all peers.
1003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001004 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001005 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001006 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1007 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1008 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001009
1010 backend mybackend
1011 mode tcp
1012 balance roundrobin
1013 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1014 stick on src
1015
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001016 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1017 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001018
1019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010204. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001022
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1024 - defaults <name>
1025 - frontend <name>
1026 - backend <name>
1027 - listen <name>
1028
1029A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1030its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1031section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001032section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001033
1034A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1035connections.
1036
1037A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1038to forward incoming connections.
1039
1040A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1041parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001043All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1044'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1045case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1046
1047Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1048logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1049proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1050However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1051name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1052
1053Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1054and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001055bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001056protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1057modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1058arbitrary criteria.
1059
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1062--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001064The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1065limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1066they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1067limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001068marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001069option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001070and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1071with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1072specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001073
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001074
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001075 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1076------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1077acl - X X X
1078appsession - - X X
1079backlog X X X -
1080balance X - X X
1081bind - X X -
1082bind-process X X X X
1083block - X X X
1084capture cookie - X X -
1085capture request header - X X -
1086capture response header - X X -
1087clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001088compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001089contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1090cookie X - X X
1091default-server X - X X
1092default_backend X X X -
1093description - X X X
1094disabled X X X X
1095dispatch - - X X
1096enabled X X X X
1097errorfile X X X X
1098errorloc X X X X
1099errorloc302 X X X X
1100-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1101errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001102force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103fullconn X - X X
1104grace X X X X
1105hash-type X - X X
1106http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001107http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001108http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109http-request - X X X
1110id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001111ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001112log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001113maxconn X X X -
1114mode X X X X
1115monitor fail - X X -
1116monitor-net X X X -
1117monitor-uri X X X -
1118option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1119option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1120option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1121option allbackups (*) X - X X
1122option checkcache (*) X - X X
1123option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1124option contstats (*) X X X -
1125option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1126option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1127option forceclose (*) X X X X
1128-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1129option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001130option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001131option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001132option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1133option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1134option httpchk X - X X
1135option httpclose (*) X X X X
1136option httplog X X X X
1137option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001138option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001139option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001140option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1141option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1142option logasap (*) X X X -
1143option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001144option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001145option nolinger (*) X X X X
1146option originalto X X X X
1147option persist (*) X - X X
1148option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001149option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150option smtpchk X - X X
1151option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1152option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1153option splice-request (*) X X X X
1154option splice-response (*) X X X X
1155option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1156option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1157-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1158option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1159option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1160option tcpka X X X X
1161option tcplog X X X X
1162option transparent (*) X - X X
1163persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1164rate-limit sessions X X X -
1165redirect - X X X
1166redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1167redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1168reqadd - X X X
1169reqallow - X X X
1170reqdel - X X X
1171reqdeny - X X X
1172reqiallow - X X X
1173reqidel - X X X
1174reqideny - X X X
1175reqipass - X X X
1176reqirep - X X X
1177reqisetbe - X X X
1178reqitarpit - X X X
1179reqpass - X X X
1180reqrep - X X X
1181-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1182reqsetbe - X X X
1183reqtarpit - X X X
1184retries X - X X
1185rspadd - X X X
1186rspdel - X X X
1187rspdeny - X X X
1188rspidel - X X X
1189rspideny - X X X
1190rspirep - X X X
1191rsprep - X X X
1192server - - X X
1193source X - X X
1194srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001195stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001196stats auth X - X X
1197stats enable X - X X
1198stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001199stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001200stats realm X - X X
1201stats refresh X - X X
1202stats scope X - X X
1203stats show-desc X - X X
1204stats show-legends X - X X
1205stats show-node X - X X
1206stats uri X - X X
1207-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1208stick match - - X X
1209stick on - - X X
1210stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001211stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001212stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001213tcp-request connection - X X -
1214tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001215tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001216tcp-response content - - X X
1217tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001218timeout check X - X X
1219timeout client X X X -
1220timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1221timeout connect X - X X
1222timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1223timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1224timeout http-request X X X X
1225timeout queue X - X X
1226timeout server X - X X
1227timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1228timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001229timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001230transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001231unique-id-format X X X -
1232unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001233use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001234use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001235------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1236 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012394.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1240---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241
1242This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1243
1244
1245acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1246 Declare or complete an access list.
1247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1248 no | yes | yes | yes
1249 Example:
1250 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1251 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1252 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001254 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001255
1256
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001257appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1258 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1261 no | no | yes | yes
1262 Arguments :
1263 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1264 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1265
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001266 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267 checked in each cookie value.
1268
1269 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1270 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1271 milliseconds.
1272
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001273 request-learn
1274 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1275 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1276 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1277 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1278 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1279 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1280
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001281 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1282 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1283 data following this prefix.
1284
1285 Example :
1286 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1287
1288 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1289 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1290
1291 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1292 2 modes are currently supported :
1293 - path-parameters :
1294 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1295 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1296 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1297 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1298 - query-string :
1299 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1300 query string.
1301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1303 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1304 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1305 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001306 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1307 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1308 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1310 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1311
1312 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1313
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001314 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1315 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1316 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001318 Example :
1319 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1320
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001321 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1322 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
1324
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001325backlog <conns>
1326 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1328 yes | yes | yes | no
1329 Arguments :
1330 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1331 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001332 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001333
1334 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1335 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1336 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1337 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1338 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1339 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1340 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1341 backlog parameter.
1342
1343 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1344 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1345 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1346
1347 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1348
1349
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001350balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001351balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001352 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1354 yes | no | yes | yes
1355 Arguments :
1356 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1357 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1358 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1359 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1360
1361 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1362 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1363 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1364 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001365 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1366 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1367 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1368 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1369 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1370 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1371 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1372 it, so that you don't worry.
1373
1374 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1375 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1376 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1377 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1378 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1379 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1380 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1381 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001382
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001383 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1384 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1385 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1386 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1387 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1388 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1389 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1390 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1391
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001392 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1393 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1394 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1395 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001396 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001397 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1398 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1399 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1400 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1401 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001402 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1403 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1404 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1405 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1406 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1407 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001409 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1410 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1411 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1412 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1413 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1414 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1415 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1416 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001417 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001419 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1420 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1421 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001423 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1424 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1425 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1426 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1427 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1428 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1429 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1430 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1431 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1432 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1433 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1434 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001435
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001436 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001437 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1438 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1439 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1440 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1441 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1442 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1443 URIs start with a leading "/".
1444
1445 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1446 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1447 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1448 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001450 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001451 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1452
1453 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001454 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1455 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1456 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1457 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1458 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1459 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1460 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1461 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1462 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1463 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1464 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1465 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1466 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1467 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1468 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1469 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1470 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1471 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1472 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001473
1474 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1475 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1476 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1477 server will receive the request.
1478
1479 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1480 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1481 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1482 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1483 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001484 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1485 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1486 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001488 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1489 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1490 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1491 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1492 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001494 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001495 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1496 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1497 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1498
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001499 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1500 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1501 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1502
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001503 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001504 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001505 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1506 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1507 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1508 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1509 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1510 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001511 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001512 used instead.
1513
1514 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1515 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1516 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1517 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1518
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001519 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1520 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1521 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1522
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001523 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001526 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1527 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001528
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001529 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001530 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001531
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001532 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1533 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1534 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535
1536 Examples :
1537 balance roundrobin
1538 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001539 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001540 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1541 balance hdr(host)
1542 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001543
1544 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1545 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001547 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001548 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1549 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1550 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1551 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1552
1553 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1554 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1555 defaults to 16 kB.
1556
1557 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1558 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1559
1560 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1561 Round Robin.
1562
1563 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1564 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1565 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1566 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1567
1568 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1569
1570 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001571 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001572 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1573 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1574 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001575
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001576 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1577 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578
1579
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001580bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1581bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001582 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1584 no | yes | yes | no
1585 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001586 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1587 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1588 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1589 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001590 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001591
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001592 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1593 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001594 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1595 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1596 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001597 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1598 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1599 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1600 the range.
1601
1602 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1603 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1604 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1605 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1606 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1607 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1608 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001609 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001610 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001612 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1613 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1614 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1615 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1616 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1617 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1618 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1619 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001621 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1622 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1623 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1624 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1627 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1628 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1629 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1630 in a frontend.
1631
1632 Example :
1633 listen http_proxy
1634 bind :80,:443
1635 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001636 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001637
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001638 listen http_https_proxy
1639 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001640 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001641
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001642 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001643 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001644
1645
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001646bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001647 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1649 yes | yes | yes | yes
1650 Arguments :
1651 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1652 may be used to override a default value.
1653
1654 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1655 option may be combined with other numbers.
1656
1657 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1658 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1659 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1660 missing from all processes.
1661
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001662 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1663 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1664 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1665 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1666 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001667
1668 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1669 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1670 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1671 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1672 and 'even' instances.
1673
1674 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1675 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1676 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1677 32.
1678
1679 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1680 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1681
1682 Example :
1683 listen app_ip1
1684 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001685 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001686
1687 listen app_ip2
1688 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001689 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001690
1691 listen management
1692 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001693 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001694
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001695 listen management
1696 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1697 bind-process 1-4
1698
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001699 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1700
1701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001702block { if | unless } <condition>
1703 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1705 no | yes | yes | yes
1706
1707 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1708 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001709 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001710 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001711 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1712 "block" statements per instance.
1713
1714 Example:
1715 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1716 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1717 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1718 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001720 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721
1722
1723capture cookie <name> len <length>
1724 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1726 no | yes | yes | no
1727 Arguments :
1728 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1729 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1730 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1731 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1732 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1733
1734 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1735 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1736 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1737 right if it exceeds <length>.
1738
1739 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1740 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1741 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1742 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1743
1744 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1745 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1746 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1747
1748 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1749 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1750 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001751 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1752 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1753 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754
1755 Example:
1756 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1757
1758 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001759 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760
1761
1762capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001763 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1765 no | yes | yes | no
1766 Arguments :
1767 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001768 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1770 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1771 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1772
1773 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1774 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1775 it exceeds <length>.
1776
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001777 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1779 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001780 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1781 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1782 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1783 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001784 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001785 environments to find where the request came from.
1786
1787 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1788 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1789 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1790 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001792 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1793 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1794 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1795 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1796 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
1798 Example:
1799 capture request header Host len 15
1800 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1801 capture request header Referrer len 15
1802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001803 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804 about logging.
1805
1806
1807capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001808 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1810 no | yes | yes | no
1811 Arguments :
1812 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001813 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1815 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1816 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1817
1818 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1819 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1820 it exceeds <length>.
1821
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001822 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1824 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1825 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001826 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1827 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1828 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1829 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001831 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1832 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1833 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1834 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1835 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
1837 Example:
1838 capture response header Content-length len 9
1839 capture response header Location len 15
1840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001841 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842 about logging.
1843
1844
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001845clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1848 yes | yes | yes | no
1849 Arguments :
1850 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1852 as explained at the top of this document.
1853
1854 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1855 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1856 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1857 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1858 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1859 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1860 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1861 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001862 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1864 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1865
1866 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1867 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1868 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1869 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1870 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1871 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1872
1873 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1874 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1875
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001876 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1877 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001879compression algo <algorithm> ...
1880compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001881compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001882 Enable HTTP compression.
1883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1884 yes | yes | yes | yes
1885 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001886 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1887 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1888 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1889
1890 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001891 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001892 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1893 data.
1894
1895 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1896 support for zlib was built in.
1897
1898 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1899 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1900 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1901 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1902 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1903 in.
1904
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001905 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001906 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001907 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1908 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1909 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1910 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1911 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001912
1913 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1914 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1915 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1916 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1917 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001918 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1919 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1920 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1921 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1922 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1923 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001924
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001925 Compression is disabled when:
1926 * the server is not HTTP/1.1.
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001927 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001928 * requests does not contain Transfer-Encoding: chunked or Content-Length.
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001929 * Content-Type is multipart
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001930 * the request contains "Cache-control: no-transform".
1931 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" except MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7 and later.
1932 * The response is already compressed (see compression offload).
1933
1934 The compression does not rewrite Etag headers
1935
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001936 Examples :
1937 compression algo gzip
1938 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001940contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 yes | no | yes | yes
1944 Arguments :
1945 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1946 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1947 as explained at the top of this document.
1948
1949 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001950 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001951 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1953 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1954 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1955 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1956
1957 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1958 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1959 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1960 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1961 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1962 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1963
1964 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1965 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1966 instead.
1967
1968 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1969 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1970
1971
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001972cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001973 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1974 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1977 yes | no | yes | yes
1978 Arguments :
1979 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1980 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1981 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1982 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1983 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1984 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1985 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1986 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1987 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1988
1989 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1990 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1991 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1992 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1993 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1994 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1995 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1996 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1997 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1998 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1999 "insert" and "prefix".
2000
2001 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002002 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002003
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002004 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002005 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2006 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2007 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2008 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2009 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2010 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2011 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2012 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2013 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2014 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015
2016 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2017 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2018 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2019 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2020 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2021 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2022 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2023 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2024 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2025 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002026 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2027 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2028 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002030 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2031 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2032 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002033 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2034 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2035 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2036 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002037 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2038 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2039 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040
2041 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2042 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2043 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2044 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2045 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2046 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2047 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2048 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2049 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2050
2051 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2052 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2053 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2054 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2055 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2056 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2057 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2058 persistence cookie in the cache.
2059 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2060
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002061 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2062 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2063 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2064 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2065 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2066 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2067 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2068 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2069 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2070 they logout.
2071
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002072 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2073 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2074 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2075 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2076
2077 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2078 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2079 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2080 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2081 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2082 this attribute.
2083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002084 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002085 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002086 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2087 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2088 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2089 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2090 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2091 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002092
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002093 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2094 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2095 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2096 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2097 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2098 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2099 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2100 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2101 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2102 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2103 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2104 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2105 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2106 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2107 the site.
2108
2109 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2110 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2111 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2112 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2113 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2114 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2115 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2116 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2117 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2118 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2119 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2120 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2121 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2122 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2123 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2124 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2127 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2128 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2129 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002130
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002131 Examples :
2132 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2133 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2134 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002135 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002137 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002138 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002141default-server [param*]
2142 Change default options for a server in a backend
2143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2144 yes | no | yes | yes
2145 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002146 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2147 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2148 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2149 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002150
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002151 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002152 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2153
2154 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157default_backend <backend>
2158 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2160 yes | yes | yes | no
2161 Arguments :
2162 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2163
2164 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2165 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2166 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2167 will catch all undetermined requests.
2168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 Example :
2170
2171 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2172 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2173 default_backend dynamic
2174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002175 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177
2178disabled
2179 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2181 yes | yes | yes | yes
2182 Arguments : none
2183
2184 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2185 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2186 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2187 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2188 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2189 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2190 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2191
2192 See also : "enabled"
2193
2194
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002195dispatch <address>:<port>
2196 Set a default server address
2197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2198 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002200
2201 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2202 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2203 during start-up.
2204
2205 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2206 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2207 possible with normal servers.
2208
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002209 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002210 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2211 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2212 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2213 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2214
2215 See also : "server"
2216
2217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002218enabled
2219 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2221 yes | yes | yes | yes
2222 Arguments : none
2223
2224 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2225 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2226
2227 See also : "disabled"
2228
2229
2230errorfile <code> <file>
2231 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2233 yes | yes | yes | yes
2234 Arguments :
2235 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002236 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237
2238 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002239 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002240 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002241 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2242 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243
2244 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2245 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2246 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2247
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002248 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002250 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2251 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2252 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2253 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2254
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002255 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2256 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2257 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2258 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2259 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2260 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2263 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2264 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002265 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2267
2268 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2269
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002270 Example :
2271 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2272 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2273 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002275
2276errorloc <code> <url>
2277errorloc302 <code> <url>
2278 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2280 yes | yes | yes | yes
2281 Arguments :
2282 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002283 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002284
2285 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2286 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2287 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2288 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2289 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2290
2291 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2292 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2293 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2294
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002295 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002297 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2298 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2299 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2300 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2301 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2302 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2303 request.
2304
2305 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2306
2307
2308errorloc303 <code> <url>
2309 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2311 yes | yes | yes | yes
2312 Arguments :
2313 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2314 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2315
2316 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2317 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2318 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2319 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2320 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2321
2322 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2323 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2324 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2325
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002326 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2327
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002328 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2329 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2330 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2331 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002332 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002333
2334 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2335
2336
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002337force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2338 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2340 no | yes | yes | yes
2341
2342 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2343 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2344 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2345 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2346 marked down for maintenance operations.
2347
2348 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2349 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2350 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2351 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2352 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2353 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2354 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2355 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2356 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2357
2358 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2359 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2360 is used.
2361
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002362 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002363 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002364
2365
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002366fullconn <conns>
2367 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 yes | no | yes | yes
2370 Arguments :
2371 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2372 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2373
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002374 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002375 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002376 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2378 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2379 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2380 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2381 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002382 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002383
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002384 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2385 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2386 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2387
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002388 Example :
2389 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2390 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2391 # connections.
2392 backend dynamic
2393 fullconn 10000
2394 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2395 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2396
2397 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2398
2399
2400grace <time>
2401 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002403 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002404 Arguments :
2405 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2406 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2407 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2408
2409 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2410 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002411 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002412 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2413
2414 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2415 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2416 simplify it.
2417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002419hash-type <method>
2420 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2422 yes | no | yes | yes
2423 Arguments :
2424 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2425 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2426 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2427 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2428 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2429 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2430 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2431 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2432 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2433
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002434 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2435 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2436 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2437 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2438 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2439 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2440 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2441 this value.
2442
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002443 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2444 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2445 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2446 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2447 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2448 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2449 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2450 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2451 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2452 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2453 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2454 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2455 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2456
2457 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2458
2459 See also : "balance", "server"
2460
2461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462http-check disable-on-404
2463 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002465 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466 Arguments : none
2467
2468 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2469 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2470 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2471 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2472 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2473 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2474 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2475 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002476 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2477 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2478 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2479
2480 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2481
2482
2483http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002484 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002486 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002487 Arguments :
2488 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2489 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002490 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002491 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2492 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2493 details on the supported keywords.
2494
2495 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2496 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2497 with the usual backslash ('\').
2498
2499 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2500 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2501 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2502 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2503 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2504
2505 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002506 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002507 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2508 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2509 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2510
2511 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002512 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002513 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2514 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2515 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2516 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2517
2518 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002519 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002520 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2521 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2522 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2523 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2524 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2525 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2526 trace).
2527
2528 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002529 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002530 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2531 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2532 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2533 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2534 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2535 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2536
2537 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2538 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2539 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2540 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2541 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2542 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2543 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2544 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2545
2546 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2547 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2548
2549 Examples :
2550 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002551 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002552
2553 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002554 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002555
2556 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002557 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002558
2559 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002560 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002562 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002563
2564
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002565http-check send-state
2566 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 yes | no | yes | yes
2569 Arguments : none
2570
2571 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2572 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2573 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2574 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2575 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2576
2577 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2578 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2579 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2580 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2581 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2582 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2583 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2584 checked in multiple backends.
2585
2586 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2587 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2588
2589 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2590 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2591 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2592 one fails.
2593
2594 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2595 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2596 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2597
2598 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2599 server's queue.
2600
2601 Example of a header received by the application server :
2602 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2603 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2604
2605 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2606
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002607http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002608 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002609 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2610
2611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | yes
2613
2614 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2615 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2616 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002617 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2618 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002619 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2620
2621 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2622 instance.
2623
2624 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002625 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2626 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2627 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002628
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002629 http-request allow if nagios
2630 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2631 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2632 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002633
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002634 Example:
2635 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002636
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002637 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002638
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002639 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2640 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002641
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002642http-send-name-header [<header>]
2643 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2644
2645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2646 yes | no | yes | yes
2647
2648 Arguments :
2649
2650 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2651
2652 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2653 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2654 is added with the header string proved.
2655
2656 See also : "server"
2657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002658id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002659 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2661 no | yes | yes | yes
2662 Arguments : none
2663
2664 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2665 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2666 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002667
2668
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002669ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2670 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2671 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2672 no | yes | yes | yes
2673
2674 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2675 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2676 and running).
2677
2678 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2679 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2680 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2681 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2682 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2683
2684 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2685 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2686
2687 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2688 "unless" condition is met.
2689
2690 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2691
2692
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002694log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002695no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002696 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2698 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002699
2700 Prefix :
2701 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2702 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2703 prefix does not allow arguments.
2704
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002705 Arguments :
2706 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2707 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2708 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2709 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2710 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2711 parameter.
2712
2713 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2714 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2715
2716 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2717 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2718 standard syslog port).
2719
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002720 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2721 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2722 standard syslog port).
2723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002724 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2725 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2726 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2727 appropriately writeable).
2728
2729 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2730
2731 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2732 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2733 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2734
2735 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2736 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2737 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002738 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2739 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2740 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2741 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2742 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002743
2744 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2745
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002746 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2747 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2748 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002749
2750 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2751 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2752 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2753 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2754
2755 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2756 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002757
2758 Example :
2759 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002760 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2761 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002762
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002763log-format <string>
2764 Allows you to custom a log line.
2765
2766 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2767
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002768
2769maxconn <conns>
2770 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 yes | yes | yes | no
2773 Arguments :
2774 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2775 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2776 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2777 closes.
2778
2779 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2780 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2781 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2782 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2783 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2784 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2785 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2786 properly tuned.
2787
2788 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2789 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2790 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2791
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002792 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2793
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002794 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2795
2796
2797mode { tcp|http|health }
2798 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2800 yes | yes | yes | yes
2801 Arguments :
2802 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2803 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2804 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2805 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2806
2807 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2808 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2809 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2810 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2811 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2812
2813 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002814 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2815 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2816 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2817 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2818 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2819 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2820 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002821
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002822 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2823 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2824 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002825
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002826 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002827 defaults http_instances
2828 mode http
2829
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002830 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002833monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002834 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 Arguments :
2838 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2839 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002840 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2842 backend and its backup.
2843
2844 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2845 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2846 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2847 servers in a list of backends.
2848
2849 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2850 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2851 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2852 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2853 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2854 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2855 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002856 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2857 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858
2859 Example:
2860 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002861 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2863 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2864 monitor-uri /site_alive
2865 monitor fail if site_dead
2866
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002867 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002868
2869
2870monitor-net <source>
2871 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2873 yes | yes | yes | no
2874 Arguments :
2875 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2876 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2877 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2878 followed by a mask.
2879
2880 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2881 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002882 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002883 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2884
2885 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2886 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2887 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2888 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002889 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2890 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2891 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002892
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002893 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2894 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2895 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2896 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2897 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2898 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002899
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002900 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2901 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002903 Example :
2904 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2905 frontend www
2906 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2907
2908 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2909
2910
2911monitor-uri <uri>
2912 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2914 yes | yes | yes | no
2915 Arguments :
2916 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2917 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2918
2919 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2920 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2921 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2922 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2923 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2924 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2925 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2926 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2927
2928 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2929 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2930 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2931 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2932 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2933 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2934
2935 Example :
2936 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2937 frontend www
2938 mode http
2939 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2940
2941 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002944option abortonclose
2945no option abortonclose
2946 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2948 yes | no | yes | yes
2949 Arguments : none
2950
2951 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2952 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2953 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2954 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002955 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002956 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2957 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2958 encountered while delivering the response.
2959
2960 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2961 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2962 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2963 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2964 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2965 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002966 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002967 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002968 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002969 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2970 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2971 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2972
2973 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2974 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2975 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2976 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2977 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2978 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2979 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2980 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002981 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002982
2983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2985
2986 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2987
2988
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002989option accept-invalid-http-request
2990no option accept-invalid-http-request
2991 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | yes | yes | no
2994 Arguments : none
2995
2996 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2997 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2998 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2999 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3000 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3001 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3002 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3003 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003004 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3005 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3006 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3007 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3008 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3009 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003010
3011 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3012 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3013 been confirmed.
3014
3015 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3016 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003017 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3018 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003019 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3020
3021 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3022 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3023
3024 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3025 stats socket.
3026
3027
3028option accept-invalid-http-response
3029no option accept-invalid-http-response
3030 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3032 yes | no | yes | yes
3033 Arguments : none
3034
3035 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3036 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3037 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3038 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3039 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3040 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3041 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3042 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3043 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3044
3045 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3046 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3047 been confirmed.
3048
3049 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3050 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3051 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3052 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3053
3054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3056
3057 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3058 stats socket.
3059
3060
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003061option allbackups
3062no option allbackups
3063 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3065 yes | no | yes | yes
3066 Arguments : none
3067
3068 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3069 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3070 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3071 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3072 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3073 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3074 order between the backup servers anymore.
3075
3076 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3077 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3078
3079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3081
3082
3083option checkcache
3084no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003085 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 yes | no | yes | yes
3088 Arguments : none
3089
3090 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3091 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003092 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003093 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3094 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003095 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003096
3097 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003098 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003099 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003100 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3101 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003102 to the client are :
3103 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003104 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003105 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003106 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3107 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3108 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3109 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3110 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3111 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3112 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3113 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3114 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3115 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3116 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3117
3118 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003119 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003120 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003121 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003122 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3123
3124 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3125 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003126 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003127 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3128
3129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3131
3132
3133option clitcpka
3134no option clitcpka
3135 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3137 yes | yes | yes | no
3138 Arguments : none
3139
3140 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3141 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3142 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3143 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3144
3145 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3146 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3147 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3148 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3149
3150 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3151 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3152 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3153 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3154 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3155
3156 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3157
3158 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3159 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3160 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3161
3162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3164
3165 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3166
3167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168option contstats
3169 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3171 yes | yes | yes | no
3172 Arguments : none
3173
3174 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3175 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3176 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3177 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3178 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3179 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3180 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3181
3182
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003183option dontlog-normal
3184no option dontlog-normal
3185 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 yes | yes | yes | no
3188 Arguments : none
3189
3190 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3191 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3192 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3193 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3194 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3195 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3196 logged.
3197
3198 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3199 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3200 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003202 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003203 logging.
3204
3205
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003206option dontlognull
3207no option dontlognull
3208 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 yes | yes | yes | no
3211 Arguments : none
3212
3213 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3214 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3215 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3216 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3217 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3218 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3219 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3220
3221 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3222 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3223 would not be logged.
3224
3225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003228 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003229
3230
3231option forceclose
3232no option forceclose
3233 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003235 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003236 Arguments : none
3237
3238 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3239 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3240 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3241 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3242 global session times in the logs.
3243
3244 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003245 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003246 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3247 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3248 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3249 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003250
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003251 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3252 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3253 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3257
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003258 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003259
3260
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003261option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003262 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3264 yes | yes | yes | yes
3265 Arguments :
3266 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3267 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003268 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003269 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003270
3271 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3272 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3273 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3274 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3275 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3276 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3277 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003278 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3279 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3280 possible that the client has already brought one.
3281
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003282 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003283 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003284 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3285 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003286 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3287 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003288
3289 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3290 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3291 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3292 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3293 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3294 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3295 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3296
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003297 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3298 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3299 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3300 are under the control of the end-user.
3301
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003302 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003303 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3304 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003305 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3306 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3307 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003308
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003309 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3310 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3311 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3312 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3313 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003314
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003315 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003316 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3317 frontend www
3318 mode http
3319 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3320
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003321 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3322 backend www
3323 mode http
3324 option forwardfor header X-Client
3325
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003326 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3327 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003328
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003329
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003330option http-no-delay
3331no option http-no-delay
3332 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 yes | yes | yes | yes
3335 Arguments : none
3336
3337 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3338 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3339 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3340 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3341 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3342 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3343 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3344 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3345 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3346 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3347 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3348 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3349 affected.
3350
3351 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3352 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3353 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3354 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3355 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3356 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3357 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3358 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3359 latency environments.
3360
3361
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003362option http-pretend-keepalive
3363no option http-pretend-keepalive
3364 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3366 yes | yes | yes | yes
3367 Arguments : none
3368
3369 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3370 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3371 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3372 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3373 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3374 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3375 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3376 consider the response complete.
3377
3378 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3379 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3380 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3381 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3382 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3383 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3384
3385 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3386 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3387 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3388 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3389 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3390 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3391 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3392
3393 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3394 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003395 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003396 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3397 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003398
3399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3401
3402 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3403
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003404
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003405option http-server-close
3406no option http-server-close
3407 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | yes
3410 Arguments : none
3411
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003412 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3413 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3414 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3415 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3416 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3417 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3418 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3419 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3420 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3421 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3422 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3423 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003424
3425 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3426 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3427 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3428 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003429 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3430 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003431
3432 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3433 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003434 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3435 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3436 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003437
3438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3440
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003441 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3442 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003443
3444
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003445option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003446no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003447 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3449 yes | yes | yes | no
3450 Arguments : none
3451
3452 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3453 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3454 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3455 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3456 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3457 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3458 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3459
3460 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3461 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3462 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3463 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3464 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3465 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3466 request along its whole life.
3467
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003468 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3469 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3470 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3471 front of an existing proxy.
3472
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003473 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3474
3475 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3476 http-server-close".
3477
3478
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003479option httpchk
3480option httpchk <uri>
3481option httpchk <method> <uri>
3482option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3483 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3485 yes | no | yes | yes
3486 Arguments :
3487 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3488 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3489 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3490 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3491 ones.
3492
3493 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3494 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3495 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3496
3497 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3498 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3499 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3500 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3501 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3502
3503 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3504 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3505 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3506 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3507 the lack of any response.
3508
3509 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3510
3511 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3512 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3513 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3514
3515 Examples :
3516 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3517 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3518 backend https_relay
3519 mode tcp
3520 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3521 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3522
3523 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003524 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3525 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003526
3527
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003528option httpclose
3529no option httpclose
3530 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : none
3534
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003535 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3536 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3537 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3538 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3539 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3540 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3541 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003542
3543 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003544 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003545 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3546 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3547 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3548 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3549 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003550
3551 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3552 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3553 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003554 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3555 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003556
3557 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3558 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3559
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003560 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3561 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003562
3563
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003564option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003565 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003568 Arguments :
3569 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3570 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3571 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3572 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3573 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003574
3575 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3576 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3577 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3578 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3579 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3580 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3581 ports.
3582
3583 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3584
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3587 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3588 by default.
3589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003590 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003591
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003592
3593option http_proxy
3594no option http_proxy
3595 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | yes | yes | yes
3598 Arguments : none
3599
3600 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3601 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3602 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3603 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3604 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3605
3606 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3607 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3608 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3609 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003610 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003611 be analyzed.
3612
3613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3615
3616 Example :
3617 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3618 backend direct_forward
3619 option httpclose
3620 option http_proxy
3621
3622 See also : "option httpclose"
3623
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003624
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003625option independent-streams
3626no option independent-streams
3627 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | yes | yes | yes
3630 Arguments : none
3631
3632 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3633 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3634 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3635 receive data or not.
3636
3637 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3638 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3639 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3640 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3641 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3642 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3643 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3644 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3645 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3646 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3647 socket buffers.
3648
3649 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3650 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3651 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3652 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3653 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3654
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003655 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3656 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3657 deprecated.
3658
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003659 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003660
3661
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003662option ldap-check
3663 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | no | yes | yes
3666 Arguments : none
3667
3668 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3669 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3670 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3671 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3672
3673 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3674 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3675
3676 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3677 configure it.
3678
3679 Example :
3680 option ldap-check
3681
3682 See also : "option httpchk"
3683
3684
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003685option log-health-checks
3686no option log-health-checks
3687 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3689 yes | no | yes | yes
3690 Arguments : none
3691
3692 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3693 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3694 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3695 of additional information is limited.
3696
3697 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3698 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3699
3700 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3701
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003702
3703option log-separate-errors
3704no option log-separate-errors
3705 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3707 yes | yes | yes | no
3708 Arguments : none
3709
3710 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3711 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3712 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3713 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3714 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3715 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3716 provides very important information.
3717
3718 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3719 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3720 error logs.
3721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003722 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003723 logging.
3724
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003725
3726option logasap
3727no option logasap
3728 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | no
3731 Arguments : none
3732
3733 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3734 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3735 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3736 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3737 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3738 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3739 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003740 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003741 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3742 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3743
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003744 Examples :
3745 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3746 mode http
3747 option httplog
3748 option logasap
3749 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3750
3751 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3752 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3753 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3754 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003756 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003757 logging.
3758
3759
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003760option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3761 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003764 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003765 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3766 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003767
3768 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3769 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3770 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3771 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3772 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3773 in the MySQL table, like this :
3774
3775 USE mysql;
3776 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3777 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3778
3779 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3780 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3781 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3782 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3783 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3784 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3785 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3786 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3787 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3788
3789 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3790 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003791
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003792 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003793
3794 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3795 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3796 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3797 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3798 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3799 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3800
3801 See also: "option httpchk"
3802
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003803option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3804 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3806 yes | no | yes | yes
3807 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003808 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3809 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003810
3811 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3812 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3813 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3814 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3815
3816 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003817
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003818option nolinger
3819no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003820 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3822 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003823 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003824
3825 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3826 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3827 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3828 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3829 connections.
3830
3831 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3832 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3833 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3834 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3835 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3836 this too.
3837
3838 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3839 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3840 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3841
3842 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3843 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3844 for servers.
3845
3846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3848
3849
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003850option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3851 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | yes
3854 Arguments :
3855 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3856 matching <network>
3857 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3858 header name.
3859
3860 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3861 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3862 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3863 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3864 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3865 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3866 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3867 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3868 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3869 possible that the client has already brought one.
3870
3871 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3872 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3873 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3874 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3875 header and requires different one.
3876
3877 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3878 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3879 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3880 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3881 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3882 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3883 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3884
3885 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3886 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3887 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3888 both are defined.
3889
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003890 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3891 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3892 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3893 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3894 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003895
3896 Examples :
3897 # Original Destination address
3898 frontend www
3899 mode http
3900 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3901
3902 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3903 backend www
3904 mode http
3905 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3906
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003907 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3908 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003909
3910
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003911option persist
3912no option persist
3913 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003916 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003917
3918 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3919 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3920 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3921 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3922 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3923 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3924 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3925 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3926 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3927 redirected to another valid server.
3928
3929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3931
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003932 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003933
3934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003935option redispatch
3936no option redispatch
3937 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3939 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003940 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003941
3942 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3943 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3944 be able to access the service anymore.
3945
3946 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3947 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3948
3949 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3950 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3951 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003953 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3954 "redisp" keywords.
3955
3956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3958
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003959 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003960
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003961
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003962option redis-check
3963 Use redis health checks for server testing
3964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | no | yes | yes
3966 Arguments : none
3967
3968 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3969 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3970 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3971 find the "+PONG" response message.
3972
3973 Example :
3974 option redis-check
3975
3976 See also : "option httpchk"
3977
3978
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003979option smtpchk
3980option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3981 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003985 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3986 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3987 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3988
3989 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3990 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3991 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3992
3993 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3994 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3995 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3996 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3997 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3998 dead server.
3999
4000 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4001 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4002 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4003 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4004
4005 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4006 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4007 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4008 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4009 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4010
4011 Example :
4012 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4013
4014 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004017option socket-stats
4018no option socket-stats
4019
4020 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4022 yes | yes | yes | no
4023
4024 Arguments : none
4025
4026
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004027option splice-auto
4028no option splice-auto
4029 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4031 yes | yes | yes | yes
4032 Arguments : none
4033
4034 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4035 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4036 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4037 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004038 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004039 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4040 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4041 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4042 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4043
4044 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4045 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4046 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4047 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4048 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4049 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4050 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4051 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4052 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4053 keyword.
4054
4055 Example :
4056 option splice-auto
4057
4058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4060
4061 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4062 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4063
4064
4065option splice-request
4066no option splice-request
4067 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4069 yes | yes | yes | yes
4070 Arguments : none
4071
4072 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004073 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004074 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4075 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4076 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4077 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4078
4079 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4080
4081 Example :
4082 option splice-request
4083
4084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4086
4087 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4088 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4089
4090
4091option splice-response
4092no option splice-response
4093 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | yes | yes | yes
4096 Arguments : none
4097
4098 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004099 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004100 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4101 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4102 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4103 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4104
4105 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4106
4107 Example :
4108 option splice-response
4109
4110 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4111 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4112
4113 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4114 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4115
4116
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004117option srvtcpka
4118no option srvtcpka
4119 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4121 yes | no | yes | yes
4122 Arguments : none
4123
4124 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4125 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4126 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4127 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4128
4129 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4130 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4131 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4132 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4133
4134 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4135 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4136 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4137 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4138 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4139
4140 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4141
4142 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4143 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4144 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4145
4146 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4147 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4148
4149 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4150
4151
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004152option ssl-hello-chk
4153 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4155 yes | no | yes | yes
4156 Arguments : none
4157
4158 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4159 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4160 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4161 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4162 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4163 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4164 hello message.
4165
4166 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4167 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4168 messages, which is appreciable.
4169
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004170 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4171 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4172 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004173
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004174 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4175
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004176
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004177option tcp-smart-accept
4178no option tcp-smart-accept
4179 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | yes | yes | no
4182 Arguments : none
4183
4184 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4185 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4186 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4187 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4188 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4189 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4190
4191 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4192 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4193 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4194 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4195
4196 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4197 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4198 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4199 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4200
4201 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4202 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4203 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4204
4205 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4206 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4207 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4208
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004209 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4210
4211
4212option tcp-smart-connect
4213no option tcp-smart-connect
4214 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | no | yes | yes
4217 Arguments : none
4218
4219 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4220 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4221 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4222 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4223 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4224
4225 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4226 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4227 complex.
4228
4229 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4230 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4231 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4232
4233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4235
4236 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4237
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004238
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004239option tcpka
4240 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4242 yes | yes | yes | yes
4243 Arguments : none
4244
4245 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4246 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4247 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4248 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4249
4250 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4251 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4252 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4253 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4254
4255 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4256 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4257 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4258 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4259 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4260
4261 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4262
4263 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4264 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4265 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4266 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4267 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4268 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4269 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4270 backends.
4271
4272 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4273
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004274
4275option tcplog
4276 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 yes | yes | yes | yes
4279 Arguments : none
4280
4281 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4282 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4283 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4284 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4285 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4286 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4287 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4288 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4289
4290 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004292 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004293
4294
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004295option transparent
4296no option transparent
4297 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004299 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004300 Arguments : none
4301
4302 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4303 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4304 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4305 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4306 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4307 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4308 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4309 appropriate server.
4310
4311 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4312 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4313
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004314 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004315 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004316
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004317
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004318persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004319persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004320 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 yes | no | yes | yes
4323 Arguments :
4324 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004325 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4326 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004327
4328 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4329 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4330 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4331 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4332 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4333 forwarded to this server.
4334
4335 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4336 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4337 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004338 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004339 a single "listen" section.
4340
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004341 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4342 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4343 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4344
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004345 Example :
4346 listen tse-farm
4347 bind :3389
4348 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4349 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4350 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4351 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4352 persist rdp-cookie
4353 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004354 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004355 balance rdp-cookie
4356 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4357 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4358
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004359 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4360 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004361
4362
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004363rate-limit sessions <rate>
4364 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 yes | yes | yes | no
4367 Arguments :
4368 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4369 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4370
4371 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4372 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4373 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4374 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4375 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4376 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4377
4378 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4379 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4380 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4381 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4382
4383 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4384 listen smtp
4385 mode tcp
4386 bind :25
4387 rate-limit sessions 10
4388 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4389
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004390 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4391 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4392 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004393
4394 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4395
4396
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004397redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4398redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4399redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004400 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 no | yes | yes | yes
4403
4404 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004405 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004406
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004407 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004408 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4409 the HTTP "Location" header.
4410
4411 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4412 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4413 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4414 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4415 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4416 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4417
4418 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4419 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4420 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4421 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4422 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4423 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4424 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4425 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4426 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004427
4428 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4429 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4430 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4431 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4432 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4433 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4434 location with a GET method.
4435
4436 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4437 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4438
4439 - "drop-query"
4440 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4441 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4442 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4443 with a location-type redirect.
4444
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004445 - "append-slash"
4446 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4447 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4448 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4449 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4450
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004451 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4452 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4453 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4454 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4455 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4456 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4457 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4458
4459 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4460 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4461 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4462 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4463 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4464 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4465 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004466
4467 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4468 acl clear dst_port 80
4469 acl secure dst_port 8080
4470 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004471 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004472 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004473 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4474
4475 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004476 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4477 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4478 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004479 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004480
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004481 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4482 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4483 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4484
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004485 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004486 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004488 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004489
4490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004491redisp (deprecated)
4492redispatch (deprecated)
4493 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004496 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004497
4498 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4499 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4500 be able to access the service anymore.
4501
4502 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4503 redistribute them to a working server.
4504
4505 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4506 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4507 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004509 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4510 "option redispatch" instead.
4511
4512 See also : "option redispatch"
4513
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004514
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004515reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4518 no | yes | yes | yes
4519 Arguments :
4520 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4521 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004522 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004523
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004524 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4525 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4526
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4528 the last header of an HTTP request.
4529
4530 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4531 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4532 responses.
4533
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004534 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4535 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4536 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4537
4538 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4539 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004540
4541
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004542reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4543reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004544 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4546 no | yes | yes | yes
4547 Arguments :
4548 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4549 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4550 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4551 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4552 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4553 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4554 ignores case.
4555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004556 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4557 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4558
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004559 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4560 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4561 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4562 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004563 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004564
4565 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4566 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4567
4568 Example :
4569 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4570 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4571 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4572
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004573 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4574 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004575
4576
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004577reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4578reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004579 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 no | yes | yes | yes
4582 Arguments :
4583 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4584 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4585 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4586 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4587 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4588 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004590 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4591 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4592
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004593 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4594 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4595 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4596 next servers.
4597
4598 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4599 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4600 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4601
4602 Example :
4603 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4604 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4605 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4606
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004607 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4608 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004609
4610
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004611reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4612reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004613 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4615 no | yes | yes | yes
4616 Arguments :
4617 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4618 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4619 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4620 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4621 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4622 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4623 case.
4624
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004625 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4626 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4627
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004628 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4629 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4630 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4631 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004632 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004633
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004634 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004635 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004636 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004637
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004638 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4639 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4640
4641 Example :
4642 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4643 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4644 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4645
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004646 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4647 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004648
4649
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004650reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4651reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004652 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4654 no | yes | yes | yes
4655 Arguments :
4656 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4657 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4658 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4659 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4660 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4661 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4662 case.
4663
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004664 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4665 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4666
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004667 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4668 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4669 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4670 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4671
4672 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4673 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4674
4675 Example :
4676 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4677 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4678 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4679 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4680
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004681 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4682 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004683
4684
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004685reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4686reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004687 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4689 no | yes | yes | yes
4690 Arguments :
4691 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4692 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4693 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4694 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4695 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4696 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4697
4698 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4699 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4700 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4701 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004702 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004704 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4705 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4706
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004707 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4708 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4709 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4710
4711 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4712 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4713 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4714 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4715 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4716
4717 Example :
4718 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004719 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4721 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4722
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004723 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4724 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004725
4726
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004727reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4728reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004729 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 no | yes | yes | yes
4732 Arguments :
4733 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4734 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4735 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4736 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4737 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4738 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4739 ignores case.
4740
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004741 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4742 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4743
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004744 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4745 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004746 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4747 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4748 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004749 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4750 not set.
4751
4752 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4753 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4754 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4755 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4756 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4757
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004758 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004759 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4760 # block all others.
4761 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4762 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4763
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004764 # block bad guys
4765 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4766 reqitarpit . if badguys
4767
4768 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4769 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004770
4771
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004772retries <value>
4773 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 yes | no | yes | yes
4776 Arguments :
4777 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4778 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4779 default value is 3.
4780
4781 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4782 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4783 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4784
4785 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4786 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4787
4788 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4789 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4790
4791 See also : "option redispatch"
4792
4793
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004794rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004795 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 no | yes | yes | yes
4798 Arguments :
4799 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4800 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004801 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004802
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004803 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4804 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4805
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004806 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4807 the last header of an HTTP response.
4808
4809 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4810 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4811 responses.
4812
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004813 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4814 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004815
4816
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004817rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4818rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004819 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 no | yes | yes | yes
4822 Arguments :
4823 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4824 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4825 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4826 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4827 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4828 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4829 ignores case.
4830
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004831 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4832 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4833
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004834 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4835 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004836 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004837 client.
4838
4839 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4840 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4841 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4842
4843 Example :
4844 # remove the Server header from responses
4845 reqidel ^Server:.*
4846
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004847 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4848 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004849
4850
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004851rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4852rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004853 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4855 no | yes | yes | yes
4856 Arguments :
4857 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4858 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4859 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4860 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4861 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4862 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4863 ignores case.
4864
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004865 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4866 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4867
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004868 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4869 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4870 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4871 case-sensitive.
4872
4873 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004874 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4875 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4876 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004877
4878 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4879 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4880
4881 Example :
4882 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4883 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4884
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004885 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4886 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004887
4888
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004889rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4890rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004891 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4893 no | yes | yes | yes
4894 Arguments :
4895 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4896 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4897 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4898 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4899 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4900 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4901 ignores case.
4902
4903 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4904 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4905 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4906 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004907 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004908
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004909 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4910 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4911
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004912 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4913 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4914 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4915
4916 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4917 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4918 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4919 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4920 are not case-sensitive.
4921
4922 Example :
4923 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4924 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4925
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004926 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4927 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004928
4929
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004930server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004931 Declare a server in a backend
4932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 no | no | yes | yes
4934 Arguments :
4935 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004936 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004937 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004938
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004939 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4940 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4941 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4942 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004943 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4944 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4945 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4946 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4947 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4948 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004949
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004950 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004951 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4952 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4953 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4954 adding this value to the client's port.
4955
4956 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4957 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004958 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004959
4960 Examples :
4961 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4962 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4963
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004964 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4965 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004966
4967
4968source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004969source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004970source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004971 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4973 yes | no | yes | yes
4974 Arguments :
4975 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4976 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4977 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4978 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4979
4980 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4981 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004982 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4983 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4984 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004985
4986 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4987 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4988 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4989 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4990 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4991 <addr>.
4992
4993 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4994 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4995 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4996 port.
4997
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004998 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4999 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5000 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5001 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
5002 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
5003 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5004 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5005 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5006 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5007 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5008 HTTP header.
5009
5010 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5011 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005012 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005013 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5014 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5015 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5016 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5017 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5018 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5019 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5020
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005021 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5022 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5023 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5024 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5025 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5026 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5027
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005028 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5029 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5030 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5031 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5032
5033 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5034 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5035 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5036 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5037 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5038 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5039
5040 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5041 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5042 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5043 there are two methods :
5044
5045 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5046 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5047 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5048 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5049 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5050 of the client ranges may be used.
5051
5052 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5053 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5054 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5055 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5056 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5057 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5058 same session.
5059
5060 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5061 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5062 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5063 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5064 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5065 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5066
5067 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5068 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5069 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005070 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005071
5072 Examples :
5073 backend private
5074 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5075 source 192.168.1.200
5076
5077 backend transparent_ssl1
5078 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5079 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5080
5081 backend transparent_ssl2
5082 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5083 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5084 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5085
5086 backend transparent_ssl3
5087 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5088 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5089 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5090
5091 backend transparent_smtp
5092 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5093 # with Tproxy version 4.
5094 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5095
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005096 backend transparent_http
5097 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5098 # proxy.
5099 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005101 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005102 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005104
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005105srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5106 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5108 yes | no | yes | yes
5109 Arguments :
5110 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5112 as explained at the top of this document.
5113
5114 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5115 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5116 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5117 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5118 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5119 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5120 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5121
5122 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5123 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5124 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5125 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5126 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005127 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005128 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005129 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005130
5131 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5132 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5133 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5134 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5135 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5136 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5137
5138 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5139 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5140
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005141 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5142 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005143
5144
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005145stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5146 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5148 no | no | yes | yes
5149
5150 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5151 matched.
5152
5153 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5154 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5155
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005156 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5157 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5158 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5159
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005160 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5161 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5162 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5163 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005164
5165 Example :
5166 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5167 backend stats_localhost
5168 stats enable
5169 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5170
5171 Example :
5172 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5173 backend stats_auth
5174 stats enable
5175 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5176 stats admin if TRUE
5177
5178 Example :
5179 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5180 userlist stats-auth
5181 group admin users admin
5182 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5183 group readonly users haproxy
5184 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5185
5186 backend stats_auth
5187 stats enable
5188 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5189 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5190 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5191 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5192
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005193 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5194 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5195 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005196
5197
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005198stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5199 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | no | yes | yes
5202 Arguments :
5203 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5204
5205 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5206
5207 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5208 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5209 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5210 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5211 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5212 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5213
5214 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5215 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5216 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005217 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005218
5219 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5220 report using "stats scope".
5221
5222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5224 unobvious parameters.
5225
5226 Example :
5227 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5228 backend public_www
5229 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5230 stats enable
5231 stats hide-version
5232 stats scope .
5233 stats uri /admin?stats
5234 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5235 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5236 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5237
5238 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5239 backend private_monitoring
5240 stats enable
5241 stats uri /admin?stats
5242 stats refresh 5s
5243
5244 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5245
5246
5247stats enable
5248 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 yes | no | yes | yes
5251 Arguments : none
5252
5253 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5254 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5255 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5256 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5257 - stats auth : no authentication
5258 - stats scope : no restriction
5259
5260 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5261 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5262 unobvious parameters.
5263
5264 Example :
5265 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5266 backend public_www
5267 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5268 stats enable
5269 stats hide-version
5270 stats scope .
5271 stats uri /admin?stats
5272 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5273 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5274 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5275
5276 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5277 backend private_monitoring
5278 stats enable
5279 stats uri /admin?stats
5280 stats refresh 5s
5281
5282 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5283
5284
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005285stats hide-version
5286 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005289 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005290
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005291 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5292 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5293 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5294 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5295 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5296 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005298 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5299 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5300 unobvious parameters.
5301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005302 Example :
5303 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5304 backend public_www
5305 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005306 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005307 stats hide-version
5308 stats scope .
5309 stats uri /admin?stats
5310 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5311 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5312 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005313
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005314 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5315 backend private_monitoring
5316 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005317 stats uri /admin?stats
5318 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005319
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005320 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005321
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005322
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005323stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5325 Access control for statistics
5326
5327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 no | no | yes | yes
5329
5330 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5331 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5332 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5333 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5334 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5335 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5336
5337 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5338 instance.
5339
5340 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5341 about ACL usage.
5342
5343
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005344stats realm <realm>
5345 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 yes | no | yes | yes
5348 Arguments :
5349 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5350 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5351 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5352
5353 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5354 using a backslash ('\').
5355
5356 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5357 only related to authentication.
5358
5359 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5360 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5361 unobvious parameters.
5362
5363 Example :
5364 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5365 backend public_www
5366 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5367 stats enable
5368 stats hide-version
5369 stats scope .
5370 stats uri /admin?stats
5371 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5372 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5373 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5374
5375 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5376 backend private_monitoring
5377 stats enable
5378 stats uri /admin?stats
5379 stats refresh 5s
5380
5381 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5382
5383
5384stats refresh <delay>
5385 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5387 yes | no | yes | yes
5388 Arguments :
5389 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5390 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5391 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5392 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5393 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5394 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5395
5396 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5397 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5398 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5399 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5400
5401 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5402 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5403 unobvious parameters.
5404
5405 Example :
5406 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5407 backend public_www
5408 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5409 stats enable
5410 stats hide-version
5411 stats scope .
5412 stats uri /admin?stats
5413 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5414 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5415 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5416
5417 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5418 backend private_monitoring
5419 stats enable
5420 stats uri /admin?stats
5421 stats refresh 5s
5422
5423 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5424
5425
5426stats scope { <name> | "." }
5427 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
5430 Arguments :
5431 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5432 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5433 section in which the statement appears.
5434
5435 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5436 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5437 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5438 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5439 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5440 exists.
5441
5442 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5443 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5444 unobvious parameters.
5445
5446 Example :
5447 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5448 backend public_www
5449 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5450 stats enable
5451 stats hide-version
5452 stats scope .
5453 stats uri /admin?stats
5454 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5455 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5456 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5457
5458 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5459 backend private_monitoring
5460 stats enable
5461 stats uri /admin?stats
5462 stats refresh 5s
5463
5464 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005466
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005467stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005468 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5470 yes | no | yes | yes
5471
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005472 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005473 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5474
5475 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5476 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5477
5478 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5479 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005480 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005481
5482 Example :
5483 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5484 backend private_monitoring
5485 stats enable
5486 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5487 stats uri /admin?stats
5488 stats refresh 5s
5489
5490 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5491 global section.
5492
5493
5494stats show-legends
5495 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5496 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5497 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5498 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5499 - IP (socket, server)
5500 - cookie (backend, server)
5501
5502 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5503 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005504 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005505
5506 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5507
5508
5509stats show-node [ <name> ]
5510 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 yes | no | yes | yes
5513 Arguments:
5514 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5515 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5516
5517 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5518 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005519 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005520
5521 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5522 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5523 unobvious parameters.
5524
5525 Example:
5526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5527 backend private_monitoring
5528 stats enable
5529 stats show-node Europe-1
5530 stats uri /admin?stats
5531 stats refresh 5s
5532
5533 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5534 section.
5535
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005536
5537stats uri <prefix>
5538 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5540 yes | no | yes | yes
5541 Arguments :
5542 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5543 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5544 query string.
5545
5546 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5547 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5548 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5549 possible to reach it in the application.
5550
5551 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005552 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005553 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5554 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5555 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5556 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5557
5558 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5559 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5560 an address or a port to statistics only.
5561
5562 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5563 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5564 unobvious parameters.
5565
5566 Example :
5567 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5568 backend public_www
5569 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5570 stats enable
5571 stats hide-version
5572 stats scope .
5573 stats uri /admin?stats
5574 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5575 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5576 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5577
5578 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5579 backend private_monitoring
5580 stats enable
5581 stats uri /admin?stats
5582 stats refresh 5s
5583
5584 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5585
5586
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005587stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5588 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005590 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005591
5592 Arguments :
5593 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5594 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5595 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5596 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5597
5598 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5599 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5600 the "stick-table" statement.
5601
5602 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5603 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5604 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5605 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5606 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5607
5608 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5609 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5610 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5611 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5612 transformation rules.
5613
5614 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5615 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5616 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5617 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5618 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5619 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5620 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5621
5622 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5623 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5624 ACL based conditions.
5625
5626 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5627 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5628 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5629 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5630
5631 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5632 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5633 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5634 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5635
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005636 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5637 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5638 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5639
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005640 Example :
5641 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5642 # last 30 minutes
5643 backend pop
5644 mode tcp
5645 balance roundrobin
5646 stick store-request src
5647 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5648 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5649 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5650
5651 backend smtp
5652 mode tcp
5653 balance roundrobin
5654 stick match src table pop
5655 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5656 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5657
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005658 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5659 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005660
5661
5662stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5663 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5665 no | no | yes | yes
5666
5667 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5668 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5669 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5670 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5671
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005672 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5673 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5674 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5675
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005676 Examples :
5677 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005678 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005679
5680 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5681 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5682 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5683
5684
5685 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5686 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5687 backend http
5688 mode http
5689 balance roundrobin
5690 stick on src table https
5691 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5692 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5693 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5694
5695 backend https
5696 mode tcp
5697 balance roundrobin
5698 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5699 stick on src
5700 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5701 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5702
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005703 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005704
5705
5706stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5707 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 no | no | yes | yes
5710
5711 Arguments :
5712 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5713 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5714 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5715 server is selected.
5716
5717 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5718 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5719 the "stick-table" statement.
5720
5721 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5722 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5723 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5724 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5725 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5726 address.
5727
5728 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5729 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5730 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5731 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5732 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5733 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5734 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5735 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5736 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5737 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5738
5739 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5740 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5741 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5742 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5743 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5744 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5745 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5746
5747 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5748 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5749 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5750 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5751
5752 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5753 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5754 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5755 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5756 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5757 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5758 another protocol or access method.
5759
5760 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5761 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5762 the request.
5763
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005764 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5765 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5766 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5767
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005768 Example :
5769 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5770 # last 30 minutes
5771 backend pop
5772 mode tcp
5773 balance roundrobin
5774 stick store-request src
5775 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5776 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5777 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5778
5779 backend smtp
5780 mode tcp
5781 balance roundrobin
5782 stick match src table pop
5783 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5784 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5785
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005786 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5787 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005788
5789
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005790stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005791 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5792 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005793 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005795 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005796
5797 Arguments :
5798 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5799 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5800 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5801 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5802
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005803 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5804 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5805 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5806 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5807
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005808 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5809 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5810 instance.
5811
5812 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5813 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5814 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5815 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5816 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5817 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005818 to 32 characters.
5819
5820 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5821 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5822 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5823 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5824 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5825 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005826
5827 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005828 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5829 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005830 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5831 increase.
5832
5833 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005834 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5835 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5836 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005837
5838 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5839 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5840 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5841 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5842 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5843 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5844 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5845 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5846 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5847 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5848 parameter (see below).
5849
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005850 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5851 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5852 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5853 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5854 soft restart.
5855
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005856 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5857
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005858 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5859 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5860 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5861 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5862 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005863 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005864 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5865 if not expiration delay is specified.
5866
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005867 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5868 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5869 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5870 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005871 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5872 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5873 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5874 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5875 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5876 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5877 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5878 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5879 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5880 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5881 types and their arguments.
5882
5883 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5884 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5885 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5886 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5887
5888 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5889 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5890 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5891 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5892
5893 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5894 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5895 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5896 they were received.
5897
5898 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5899 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5900 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5901 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5902 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5903
5904 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5905 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5906 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5907 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5908 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5909
5910 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5911 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5912 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5913
5914 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5915 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5916 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5917 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5918 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5919
5920 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5921 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5922 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5923 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5924 the client side.
5925
5926 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5927 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5928 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5929 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5930 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5931 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5932 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5933
5934 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5935 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5936 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5937 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5938 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5939 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5940 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5941
5942 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5943 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5944 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5945 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5946 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5947 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5948
5949 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5950 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5951 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5952 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5953
5954 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5955 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5956 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5957 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5958 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5959 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5960 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5961 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5962 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5963 recommended for better fairness.
5964
5965 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5966 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5967 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5968 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5969
5970 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5971 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5972 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5973 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5974 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5975 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5976 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5977 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5978 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5979 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005980
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005981 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5982 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005983 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5984 reference it.
5985
5986 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5987 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5988 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5989 as an exclusive stickiness.
5990
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005991 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5992 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5993 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5994 something that can be ignored.
5995
5996 Example:
5997 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5998 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5999 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6000 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6001
6002 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006003 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006004
6005
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006006stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6007 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6009 no | no | yes | yes
6010
6011 Arguments :
6012 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6013 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6014 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6015 server is selected.
6016
6017 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6018 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6019 the "stick-table" statement.
6020
6021 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6022 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6023 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6024 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6025
6026 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6027 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6028 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6029 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6030 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6031 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006032 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006033 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6034 rules.
6035
6036 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6037 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6038 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6039 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6040 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6041 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6042 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6043
6044 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6045 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6046 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6047 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6048
6049 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6050 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6051 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6052 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6053 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6054 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6055 another protocol or access method.
6056
6057 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6058
6059 Example :
6060 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6061 backend https
6062 mode tcp
6063 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006064 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006065 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006066
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006067 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6068 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6069
6070 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6071 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6072 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6073
6074 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6075 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006076
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006077 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6078 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6079 # at offset 44.
6080
6081 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6082 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6083
6084 # Learn on response if server hello.
6085 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006086
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006087 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6088 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6089
6090 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6091 extraction.
6092
6093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006094tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6095 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006098 Arguments :
6099 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6100 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6101 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006103 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006104
6105 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6106 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006107 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6108 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6109 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6110 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6111 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6112 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006114 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6115 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6116 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6117 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006119 Three types of actions are supported :
6120 - accept :
6121 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6122 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6123 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 - reject :
6126 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6127 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6128 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6129 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6130 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6131 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6132 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6133 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6134 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6135 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6136 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6137 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006139 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6140 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6141 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6142 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6143 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6144 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6145 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6146 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6147 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006149 These actions take one or two arguments :
6150 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6151 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6152 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006154 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6155 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6156 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6157 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006159 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6160 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6161 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6162 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6163 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6164 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6165 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6166 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6167 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6168 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006170 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6171 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6172 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006174 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6175 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6176 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006177
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006178 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006179 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006180 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006182 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6183 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6184 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006186 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6187 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6188 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006189
6190 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006192 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006193
6194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006195tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6196 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006198 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006199 Arguments :
6200 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6201 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6202 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006204 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006206 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6207 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6208 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6209 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6210 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006212 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6213 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6214 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6215 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6216 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6217 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6218 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6219 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6220 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006222 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6223 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6224 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6225 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006227 Three types of actions are supported :
6228 - accept :
6229 - reject :
6230 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006232 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6233 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006234
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006235 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6236 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6237 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6238 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6239 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6240 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006242 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006243 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6244 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006246 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006247 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6248 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6249 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6250 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6251 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006252
6253 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006254 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6255 # and reject everything else.
6256 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6257 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006258 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006259 tcp-request content reject
6260
6261 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006262 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6263 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6264 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006265 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006266
6267 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6268 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6269 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006270 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006271 tcp-request content reject
6272
6273 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6274 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6275
6276 frontend http
6277 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6278 # protecting all our sites
6279 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6280 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6281 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6282 ...
6283 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6284
6285 backend http_dynamic
6286 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6287 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6288 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6289 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6290 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6291 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6292 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006294 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006296 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006297
6298
6299tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6300 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006302 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006303 Arguments :
6304 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6305 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6306 as explained at the top of this document.
6307
6308 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6309 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6310 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6311 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6312 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6313
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006314 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6315 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6316 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6317 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6318
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006319 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6320 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006321 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006322 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006323 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6324 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6325 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6326 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006327
6328 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6329 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6330 it pass through unaffected.
6331
6332 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6333 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6334 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006335 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006336 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6337 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006338 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6339 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6340 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006341
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006342 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006343 "timeout client".
6344
6345
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006346tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6347 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 no | no | yes | yes
6350 Arguments :
6351 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6352 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6353 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6354
6355 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6356
6357 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6358 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6359 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6360 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006361 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006362
6363 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6364
6365 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6366 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6367 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6368 inserted.
6369
6370 Two types of actions are supported :
6371 - accept :
6372 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6373 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6374 the rules evaluation.
6375
6376 - reject :
6377 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6378 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006379 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006380
6381 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6382 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6383 for changing the default action to a reject.
6384
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006385 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6386 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6387 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6388 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006389 period.
6390
6391 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6392
6393 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6394
6395
6396tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6397 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 no | no | yes | yes
6400 Arguments :
6401 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6402 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6403 as explained at the top of this document.
6404
6405 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6406
6407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006408timeout check <timeout>
6409 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6410 established.
6411
6412 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6413 yes | no | yes | yes
6414 Arguments:
6415 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6416 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6417 as explained at the top of this document.
6418
6419 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6420 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6421 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6422 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006423 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6424 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6425 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006426
6427 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6428 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6429
6430 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6431 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006432 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006433
6434 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6435 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6436 forget about it.
6437
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006438 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6439 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006440
6441
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006442timeout client <timeout>
6443timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6444 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | yes | yes | no
6447 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006448 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006449 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6450 as explained at the top of this document.
6451
6452 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6453 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6454 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6455 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6456 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6457 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6458 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6459 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006460 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006461 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006462 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6463 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6464 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006465
6466 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6467 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6468 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6469 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6470 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6471 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6472
6473 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6474 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6475 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6476
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006477 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006478
6479
6480timeout connect <timeout>
6481timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6482 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 yes | no | yes | yes
6485 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006486 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6488 as explained at the top of this document.
6489
6490 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006491 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006492 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006493 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006494 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6495 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006496
6497 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6498 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6499 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6500 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6501 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6502 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6503
6504 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6505 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6506 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6507
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006508 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6509 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006510
6511
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006512timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6513 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 yes | yes | yes | yes
6516 Arguments :
6517 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6519 as explained at the top of this document.
6520
6521 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6522 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6523 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6524 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6525 once the request has started to present itself.
6526
6527 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6528 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6529 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6530 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6531 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6532
6533 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6534 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6535 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6536 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6537
6538 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6539 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6540 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6541 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6542 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006543 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006544
6545 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6546 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6547 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6548 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6549
6550 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6551
6552
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006553timeout http-request <timeout>
6554 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006558 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006559 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6560 as explained at the top of this document.
6561
6562 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6563 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6564 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6565 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6566 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6567 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6568 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6569 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6570
6571 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6572 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006573 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6574 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006575
6576 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6577 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6578 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6579 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6580 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6581
6582 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006583 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6584 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6585 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006586
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006587 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006588
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006589
6590timeout queue <timeout>
6591 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6593 yes | no | yes | yes
6594 Arguments :
6595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6597 as explained at the top of this document.
6598
6599 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6600 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6601 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6602 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6603 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6604
6605 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6606 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6607 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6608 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6609
6610 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6611
6612
6613timeout server <timeout>
6614timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6615 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6617 yes | no | yes | yes
6618 Arguments :
6619 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6620 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6621 as explained at the top of this document.
6622
6623 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6624 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6625 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6626 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6627 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6628 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6629 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6630
6631 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6632 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6633 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6634 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6635 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006636 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006637 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006638 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6639 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6640 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6641 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006642
6643 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6644 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6645 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6646 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6647 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6648 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6649
6650 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6651 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6652 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6653
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006654 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006655
6656
6657timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006658 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 yes | yes | yes | yes
6661 Arguments :
6662 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6663 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6664 as explained at the top of this document.
6665
6666 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6667 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6668 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6669
6670 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6671 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6672 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6673 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006674 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006675
6676 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6677
6678
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006679timeout tunnel <timeout>
6680 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6682 yes | no | yes | yes
6683 Arguments :
6684 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6685 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6686 as explained at the top of this document.
6687
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006688 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006689 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6690 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6691 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6692 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6693 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6694 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6695 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6696 specified.
6697
6698 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6699 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6700 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6701 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6702 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6703
6704 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6705 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6706 forget about it.
6707
6708 Example :
6709 defaults http
6710 option http-server-close
6711 timeout connect 5s
6712 timeout client 30s
6713 timeout client 30s
6714 timeout server 30s
6715 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6716
6717 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6718
6719
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006720transparent (deprecated)
6721 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006723 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006724 Arguments : none
6725
6726 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6727 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6728 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6729 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6730 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6731 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6732 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6733 appropriate server.
6734
6735 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6736
6737 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6738 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6739
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006740 See also: "option transparent"
6741
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006742unique-id-format <string>
6743 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | yes | yes | no
6746 Arguments :
6747 <string> is a log-format string.
6748
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006749 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6750 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6751 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6752 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006753
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006754 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6755 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6756 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6757 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6758 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6759 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6760 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6761 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006762
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006763 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6764 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006765
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006766 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006767
6768 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6769
6770 will generate:
6771
6772 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6773
6774 See also: "unique-id-header"
6775
6776unique-id-header <name>
6777 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6779 yes | yes | yes | no
6780 Arguments :
6781 <name> is the name of the header.
6782
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006783 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6784 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006785
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006786 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006787
6788 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6789 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6790
6791 will generate:
6792
6793 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6794
6795 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006796
6797use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6798use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006799 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6801 no | yes | yes | no
6802 Arguments :
6803 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006805 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006806
6807 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6808 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6809 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006810 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6811 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6812 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6813 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006814
6815 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6816 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6817 assign the backend.
6818
6819 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6820 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6821 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6822 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6823 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6824 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6825
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006826 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006827 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006828 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6829 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6830 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6831
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006832 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006833
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006834
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006835use-server <server> if <condition>
6836use-server <server> unless <condition>
6837 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6839 no | no | yes | yes
6840 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006841 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006842
6843 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6844
6845 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6846 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6847 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6848
6849 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6850 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6851 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6852 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6853 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6854 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6855 matches will assign the server.
6856
6857 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6858 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6859 with the next rules until one matches.
6860
6861 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6862 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6863 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6864 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6865
6866 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6867 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6868 stripped.
6869
6870 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6871 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6872 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6873 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6874
6875 Example :
6876 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6877 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6878 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6879 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6880 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6881 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6882 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6883 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6884 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6885
6886 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6887
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006888
68895. Bind and Server options
6890--------------------------
6891
6892The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6893depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6894settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6895written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6896described in this section.
6897
6898
68995.1. Bind options
6900-----------------
6901
6902The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6903as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6904no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6905parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6906while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6907provided immediately after the setting name.
6908
6909The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6910
6911accept-proxy
6912 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6913 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6914 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6915 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6916 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6917 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6918 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6919 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6920 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6921 usable.
6922
6923backlog <backlog>
6924 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6925 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6926
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006927ecdhe <named curve>
6928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6929 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6930 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6931
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006932ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6934 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6935 client's certificate.
6936
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006937ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6939 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6940 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6941 error is ignored.
6942
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006943ciphers <ciphers>
6944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6945 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6946 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6947 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6948 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6949
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006950crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6952 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6953 to verify client's certificate.
6954
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006955crt <cert>
6956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6957 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6958 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006959 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6960 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6961 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6962 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6963 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6964 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6965 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6966 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006967 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006968 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6969 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6970 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6971 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6972 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006973
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006974crt-ignore-err <errors>
6975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6976 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6977 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6978 error is ignored.
6979
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006980defer-accept
6981 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6982 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6983 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6984 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6985 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6986 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6987 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6988 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6989 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6990 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6991 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6992
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006993force-sslv3
6994 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6995 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6996 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6997
6998force-tlsv10
6999 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7000 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7001
7002force-tlsv11
7003 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7004 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7005
7006force-tlsv12
7007 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7008 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007010gid <gid>
7011 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7012 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7013 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7014 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7015 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7016
7017group <group>
7018 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7019 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7020 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7021 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7022 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7023
7024id <id>
7025 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7026 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7027 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7028 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7029
7030interface <interface>
7031 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
7032 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
7033 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
7034 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
7035 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
7036 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
7037 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
7038 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
7039
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007040level <level>
7041 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7042 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7043 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7044 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7045 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7046 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7047 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7048 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7049 counters).
7050 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7051 all counters).
7052
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007053maxconn <maxconn>
7054 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7055 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7056 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7057 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7058 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7059 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7060 eat all memory.
7061
7062mode <mode>
7063 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7064 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7065 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7066 UNIX sockets.
7067
7068mss <maxseg>
7069 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7070 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7071 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7072 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7073 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7074 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7075 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7076 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7077 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7078 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7079 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7080
7081name <name>
7082 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7083 page.
7084
7085nice <nice>
7086 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7087 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7088 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7089 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7090 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7091 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7092 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7093 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7094 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7095 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7096 one for an RDP socket.
7097
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007098no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7100 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7101 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007102 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7103 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007104
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007105no-tls-tickets
7106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7107 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7108 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7109 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7110
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007111no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007113 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7114 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7115 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7116 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007117
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007118no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007120 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7121 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7122 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7123 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007124
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007125no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007127 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7128 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7129 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7130 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007131
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007132npn <protocols>
7133 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7134 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7135 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7136 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7137 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007139ssl
7140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7141 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7142 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7143 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7144 to deciphered contents.
7145
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007146tfo
7147 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7148 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7149 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7150 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7151 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7152 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7153 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7154 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7155 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7156
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007157transparent
7158 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7159 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7160 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7161 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7162 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7163 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7164 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7165 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7166 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7167 so check for support with your vendor.
7168
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007169v4v6
7170 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7171 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7172 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7173 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7174 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7175
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007176v6only
7177 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7178 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7179 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007180 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7181 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007182
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007183uid <uid>
7184 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7185 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7186 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7187 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7188 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7189
7190user <user>
7191 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7192 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7193 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7194 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7195 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7196
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007197verify [none|optional|required]
7198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7199 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7200 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7201 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7202 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007203 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7204 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7205 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7206 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007207
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020072085.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007209------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007211The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7212which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7213arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7214settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7215after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7216Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7217address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007219 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007220 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007222The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007223
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007224addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007225 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7226 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7227 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7228 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7229 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007231 Supported in default-server: No
7232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233backup
7234 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7235 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7236 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7237 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7238 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7239 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007241 Supported in default-server: No
7242
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007243ca-file <cafile>
7244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7245 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7246 server's certificate.
7247
7248 Supported in default-server: No
7249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007250check
7251 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007252 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7253 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7254 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7255 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7256 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7257 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7258 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7259 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7260 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7261 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007263 Supported in default-server: No
7264
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007265check-send-proxy
7266 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7267 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7268 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7269 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7270 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7271 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7272 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7273
7274 Supported in default-server: No
7275
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007276check-ssl
7277 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7278 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7279 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7280 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7281 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7282 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7283 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7284 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7285 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7286
7287 Supported in default-server: No
7288
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007289ciphers <ciphers>
7290 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7291 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7292 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7293 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7294 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7295 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7296 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7297 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7298
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007299 Supported in default-server: No
7300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007301cookie <value>
7302 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7303 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7304 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7305 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7306 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7307 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7308 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007310 Supported in default-server: No
7311
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007312crl-file <crlfile>
7313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7314 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7315 to verify server's certificate.
7316
7317 Supported in default-server: No
7318
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007319crt <cert>
7320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7321 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7322 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7323 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7324 certificate request.
7325
7326 Supported in default-server: No
7327
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007328disabled
7329 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7330 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7331 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7332 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7333 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7334
7335 Supported in default-server: No
7336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007337error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007338 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7339 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7340 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007342 Supported in default-server: Yes
7343
7344 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007346fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007347 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7348 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7349 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007351 Supported in default-server: Yes
7352
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007353force-sslv3
7354 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7355 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7356 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7357
7358 Supported in default-server: No
7359
7360force-tlsv10
7361 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7362 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7363
7364 Supported in default-server: No
7365
7366force-tlsv11
7367 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7368 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7369
7370 Supported in default-server: No
7371
7372force-tlsv12
7373 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7374 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7375
7376 Supported in default-server: No
7377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007378id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007379 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7380 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7381 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007383 Supported in default-server: No
7384
7385inter <delay>
7386fastinter <delay>
7387downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007388 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7389 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7390 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7391 between checks depending on the server state :
7392
7393 Server state | Interval used
7394 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7395 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7396 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7397 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7398 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7399 or yet unchecked. |
7400 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7401 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7402 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007404 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7405 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7406 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7407 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7408 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7409 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7410 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7411 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7412 servers.
7413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007414 Supported in default-server: Yes
7415
7416maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007417 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7418 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7419 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7420 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7421 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7422 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7423 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7424 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007426 Supported in default-server: Yes
7427
7428maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007429 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7430 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7431 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7432 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7433 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7434 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7435 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007437 Supported in default-server: Yes
7438
7439minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007440 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7441 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7442 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7443 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7444 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7445 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007446 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007447 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007449 Supported in default-server: Yes
7450
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007451no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007452 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7453 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007454 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007455
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007456 Supported in default-server: No
7457
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007458no-tls-tickets
7459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7460 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7461 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7462 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7463
7464 Supported in default-server: No
7465
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007466no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007467 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007468 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7469 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007470 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7471 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007472
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007473 Supported in default-server: No
7474
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007475no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007476 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007477 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7478 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007479 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7480 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007481
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007482 Supported in default-server: No
7483
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007484no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007485 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007486 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7487 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007488 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7489 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007490
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007491 Supported in default-server: No
7492
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007493non-stick
7494 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7495 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7496 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7497
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007498 Supported in default-server: No
7499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007500observe <mode>
7501 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7502 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7503 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7504 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7505 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7506 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007507 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007509 Supported in default-server: No
7510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007511 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007513on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007514 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7515 Currently, four modes are available:
7516 - fastinter: force fastinter
7517 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7518 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7519 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7520 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007522 Supported in default-server: Yes
7523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007524 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7525
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007526on-marked-down <action>
7527 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7528 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007529 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7530 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7531 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7532 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7533 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7534 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7535 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7536 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007537
7538 Actions are disabled by default
7539
7540 Supported in default-server: Yes
7541
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007542on-marked-up <action>
7543 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7544 Currently one action is available:
7545 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7546 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7547 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7548 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7549 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7550 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7551 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7552 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7553
7554 Actions are disabled by default
7555
7556 Supported in default-server: Yes
7557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007558port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007559 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7560 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7561 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7562 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7563 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7564 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007566 Supported in default-server: Yes
7567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007568redir <prefix>
7569 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7570 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7571 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7572 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7573 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7574 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7575 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7576 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007577 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007578 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7579 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7580 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7581 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7582 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7583
7584 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007586 Supported in default-server: No
7587
7588rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007589 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7590 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7591 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007593 Supported in default-server: Yes
7594
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007595send-proxy
7596 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7597 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7598 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7599 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7600 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7601 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7602 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7603 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7604 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007605 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7606 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7607 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7608 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7609 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007610
7611 Supported in default-server: No
7612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007613slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007614 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7615 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7616 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7617 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7618 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7619 parameters :
7620
7621 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7622 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7623
7624 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7625 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7626 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7627 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7628
7629 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7630 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7631 seen as failed.
7632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007633 Supported in default-server: Yes
7634
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007635source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007636source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007637source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007638 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7639 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7640 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7641 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7642
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007643 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7644 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7645 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7646 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7647 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7648 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7649 server.
7650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007651 Supported in default-server: No
7652
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007653ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007654 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7655 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7656 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7657 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7658 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7659 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7660 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7661 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7662
7663 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007665track [<proxy>/]<server>
7666 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7667 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7668 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7669 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7670 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007672 Supported in default-server: No
7673
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007674verify [none|required]
7675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7676 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7677 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7678 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7679 is aborted.
7680
7681 Supported in default-server: No
7682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007683weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007684 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7685 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7686 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007687 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7688 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7689 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7690 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7691 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7692 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007694 Supported in default-server: Yes
7695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007696
76976. HTTP header manipulation
7698---------------------------
7699
7700In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7701response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7702request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7703which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7704against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7705to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7706passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7707headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7708never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7709
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007710There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7711(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7712rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7713messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7714in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007715happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007716add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7717normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007719This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7720in section 4.2 :
7721
7722 - reqadd <string>
7723 - reqallow <search>
7724 - reqiallow <search>
7725 - reqdel <search>
7726 - reqidel <search>
7727 - reqdeny <search>
7728 - reqideny <search>
7729 - reqpass <search>
7730 - reqipass <search>
7731 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7732 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7733 - reqtarpit <search>
7734 - reqitarpit <search>
7735 - rspadd <string>
7736 - rspdel <search>
7737 - rspidel <search>
7738 - rspdeny <search>
7739 - rspideny <search>
7740 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7741 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7742
7743With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7744is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7745parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7746prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7747Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7748
7749 \t for a tab
7750 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7751 \n for a new line (LF)
7752 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7753 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7754 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7755 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7756 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7757
7758The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7759portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7760above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7761regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
77629 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7763is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7764
7765The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7766after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7767
7768Notes related to these keywords :
7769---------------------------------
7770 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7771 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7772 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7773
7774 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7775 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7776 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7777
7778 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7779 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7780 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7781 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7782 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7783
7784 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7785 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7786 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7787 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7788 useless headers before adding new ones.
7789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007790 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007791 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7792
7793 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7794 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7795 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7796
7797 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7798 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007799 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007800
7801
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078027. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7803------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007804
7805The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7806content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7807from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7808simple :
7809
7810 - define test criteria with sets of values
7811 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7812
7813The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7814
7815In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7816
7817 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7818
7819This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7820Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7821and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7822an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7823of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7824
7825ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7826'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7827which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7828
7829There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7830performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7831
7832The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7833
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007834 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7835 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007836 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7837
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007838The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7839specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7840possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007841multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7842be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7843needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7844space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7845match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7846lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7847duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007848to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007849instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007850
7851 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7852
7853In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7854the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7855case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7856too.
7857
7858Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7859a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7860ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7861
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007862Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007863
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007864 - integers or integer ranges
7865 - strings
7866 - regular expressions
7867 - IP addresses and networks
7868
7869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078707.1. Matching integers
7871----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007872
7873Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7874that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7875expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7876may be omitted.
7877
7878For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7879unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7880representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7881
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007882As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7883two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7884instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7885ranges and operators.
7886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007887For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007888operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7889Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7890of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007892Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007893
7894 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7895 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7896 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7897 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7898 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007900For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007901
7902 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7903
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007904This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7905
7906 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079097.2. Matching strings
7910---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007911
7912String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7913exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7914characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7915string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7916to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007917before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007918
7919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079207.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7921-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007922
7923Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7924they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7925possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7926passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7927the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007928the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7929match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007930
7931
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020079327.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007933----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007934
7935IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7936netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7937within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007938host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007939difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7940at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7941does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7942parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007943
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007944IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7945Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7946trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7947IPv6 patterns.
7948
7949HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7950following situations :
7951 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7952 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7953 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7954 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7955 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7956 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7957 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7958 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7959 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7960 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079637.5. Available matching criteria
7964--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7967------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007968
7969A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7970analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007971addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007973always_false
7974 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7975 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7976
7977always_true
7978 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7979 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7980
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007981avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007982avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7984 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7985 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7986 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7987 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7988 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7989 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7990 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7991 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7992 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7993 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007994
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007995be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007996be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007997 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7998 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7999 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8000 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8001 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008002
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008003be_id <integer>
8004 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8005 backend it was called.
8006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008007be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008008be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008009 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8010 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8011 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8012 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8013 sucking of an online dictionary).
8014
8015 Example :
8016 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8017 backend dynamic
8018 mode http
8019 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8020 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008021
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008022connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008023connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008024 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008025 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008026 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8027
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008028 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8029 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008030
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008031 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008032 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8033 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8034 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8035 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8036 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008037 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008038
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008039 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8040 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8041 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8042 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008043
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008044dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008045 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8046 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008047
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008048dst_conn <integer>
8049 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8050 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8051 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8052 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8053 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8054 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8055
8056dst_port <integer>
8057 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8058 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8059
8060fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008061fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008062 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8063 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8064 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8065 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8066 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8067 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8068 criteria.
8069
8070fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008071 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008072 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008073
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008074fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008075fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008076 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8077 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8078 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8079 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8080 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8081 the rate to go down below the limit.
8082
8083 Example :
8084 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8085 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8086 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8087 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8088 frontend mail
8089 bind :25
8090 mode tcp
8091 maxconn 100
8092 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8093 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8094 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8095 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008096
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008097nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008098nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008099 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8100 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8101 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8102 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8103 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008104
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008105queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008106queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008107 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8108 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8109 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8110 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8111 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8112 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8113 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008115sc1_bytes_in_rate
8116sc2_bytes_in_rate
8117 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8118 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8119 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8120
8121sc1_bytes_out_rate
8122sc2_bytes_out_rate
8123 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8124 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8125 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8126
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008127sc1_clr_gpc0
8128sc2_clr_gpc0
8129 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8130 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8131 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8132 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8133 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8134 was verified :
8135
8136 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8137 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8138 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8139 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8140 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8141 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8142 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008144sc1_conn_cnt
8145sc2_conn_cnt
8146 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8147 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8148
8149sc1_conn_cur
8150sc2_conn_cur
8151 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8152 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8153 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8154
8155sc1_conn_rate
8156sc2_conn_rate
8157 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8158 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8159 See also src_conn_rate.
8160
8161sc1_get_gpc0
8162sc2_get_gpc0
8163 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8164 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8165
8166sc1_http_err_cnt
8167sc2_http_err_cnt
8168 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8169 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8170 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8171
8172sc1_http_err_rate
8173sc2_http_err_rate
8174 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8175 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8176 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8177 src_http_err_rate.
8178
8179sc1_http_req_cnt
8180sc2_http_req_cnt
8181 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8182 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8183 src_http_req_cnt.
8184
8185sc1_http_req_rate
8186sc2_http_req_rate
8187 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8188 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8189 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8190 src_http_req_rate.
8191
8192sc1_inc_gpc0
8193sc2_inc_gpc0
8194 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8195 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8196 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8197 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8198 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8199 when a first ACL was verified :
8200
8201 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8202 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8203 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8204
8205sc1_kbytes_in
8206sc2_kbytes_in
8207 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8208 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8209 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8210 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8211
8212sc1_kbytes_out
8213sc2_kbytes_out
8214 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8215 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8216 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8217 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8218
8219sc1_sess_cnt
8220sc2_sess_cnt
8221 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8222 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8223 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8224 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008225 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008226 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8227
8228sc1_sess_rate
8229sc2_sess_rate
8230 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8231 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8232 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8233 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8234 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008235 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008236
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008237so_id <integer>
8238 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8239
8240src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008241 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8242 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8243 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008244
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008245src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008246src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008247 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8248 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8249 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008250 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008251
8252src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008253src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008254 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8255 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8256 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008257 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008258
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008259src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8260src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8261 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8262 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8263 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8264 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8265 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8266 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8267
8268 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8269 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8270 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8271 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8272 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8273 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8274 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8275
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008276src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008277src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008278 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8279 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8280 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008281 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008282
8283src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008284src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008285 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8286 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8287 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008288 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008289
8290src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008291src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008292 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8293 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8294 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008295 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008296
8297src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008298src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008299 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8300 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8301 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008302 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008303
8304src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008305src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008306 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8307 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8308 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008309 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008310
8311src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008312src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008313 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8314 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8315 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8316 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008317 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008318
8319src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008320src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008321 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8322 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8323 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008324 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008325
8326src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008327src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008328 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8329 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8330 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8331 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008332 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008333
8334src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008335src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008336 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8337 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8338 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8339 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8340 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8341 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8342
8343 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8344 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008345 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008346
8347src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008348src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008349 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8350 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8351 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8352 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008353 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008354
8355src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008356src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008357 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8358 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8359 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8360 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008361 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008362
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008363src_port <integer>
8364 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008365
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008366src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008367src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008368 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8369 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8370 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8371 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008372 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008373
8374src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008375src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008376 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8377 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8378 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8379 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008380 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008381
8382src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008383src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008384 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008385 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8386 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008387 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8388 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8389 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008390 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008391
8392 Example :
8393 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8394 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8395 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8396 listen ssh
8397 bind :22
8398 mode tcp
8399 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008400 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008401 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8402 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8403
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008404srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008405 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8406 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8407 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8408 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8409
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008410srv_id <integer>
8411 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8412
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008413srv_is_up(<server>)
8414srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8415 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8416 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8417 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8418 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8419 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8420 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8421 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8422 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8423
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008424table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008425table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008426 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8427 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8428
8429table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008430table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008431 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8432 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8433 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8434
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020084367.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8437---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008438
8439A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8440during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008441through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8442keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008443
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008444rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8445 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8446 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8447 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008448 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8449 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8450 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008451
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008452req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008453 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008454 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8455 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8456 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8457 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8458 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8459 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8460
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008461req_proto_http
8462 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8463 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008464 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008465 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8466 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8467
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008468req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008469req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008470 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8471 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8472 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8473 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8474 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8475 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8476 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8477 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8478
8479req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008480req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008481 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8482 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8483 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8484 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8485 cookies.
8486
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008487req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8488 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8489 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8490 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008491 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8492 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8493 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008494
8495req_ssl_sni <string>
8496 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8497 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8498 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8499 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8500 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8501 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8502 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008503 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8504 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008505 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008506 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008507
8508 Examples :
8509 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8510 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8511 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8512 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8513 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8514
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008515req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8516 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8517 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8518 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8519 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8520 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8521 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008522 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8523 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008524 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008525 option.
8526
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008527ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8528 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8529 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8530 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8531 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8532 during this verification process.
8533
8534ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8535 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8536 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8537 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8538 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8539
8540ssl_c_err <integer>
8541 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8542 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8543 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8544 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8545
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008546ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8547ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8548 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8549 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8550 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8551 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8552 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8553 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8554 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8555 DN matches the specified string.
8556
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008557ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8558 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8559 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8560 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8561
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008562ssl_c_notafter <string>
8563 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8564 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8565 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8566
8567ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8568 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8569 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8570 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8571
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008572ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8573ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8574 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8575 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8576 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8577 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8578 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8579 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8580 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8581 DN matches the specified string.
8582
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008583ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8584 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8585 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8586 the value written in hexa.
8587
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008588ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8589 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8590 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8591 by the client matches the string.
8592
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008593ssl_c_verify <integer>
8594 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8595 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8596 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8597
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008598ssl_c_version <integer>
8599 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8600 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8601 the value.
8602
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008603ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8604ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8605 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8606 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8607 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8608 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8609 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8610 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8611 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8612 DN matches the specified string.
8613
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008614ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8615 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8616 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8617 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8618
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008619ssl_f_notafter <string>
8620 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8621 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8622 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8623
8624ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8625 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8626 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8627 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8628
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008629ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8630ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8631 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8632 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8633 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8634 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8635 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8636 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8637 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8638 DN matches the specified string.
8639
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008640ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8641 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8642 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8643 the value written in hexa.
8644
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008645ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8646 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8647 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8648 by the frontend matches the string.
8649
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008650ssl_f_version <integer>
8651 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8652 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8653 the value.
8654
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008655ssl_fc
8656 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8657 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8658 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8659
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008660ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8661 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8662 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8663
8664ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8665 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8666 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8667
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008668ssl_fc_has_crt
8669 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8670 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8671
8672ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008673 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008674 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8675 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8676 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8677 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008678
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008679ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008680 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8681 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8682 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8683 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008684 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8685 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8686 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008687
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008688ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8689 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8690 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8691
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008692ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008693 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8694 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8695 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8696 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008697 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8698 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008699 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8700 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8701 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008702
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008703ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008704 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8705 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8706 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8707 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008708 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8709 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8710 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8711 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008712
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008713ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008714 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8715 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8716 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8717 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008718 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8719 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8720 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8721 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008722
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008723ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8724 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8725 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8726
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008727wait_end
8728 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8729 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8730 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8731 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8732 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8733 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8734 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8735 inspection.
8736
8737 Examples :
8738 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8739 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8740 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8741
8742 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8743 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8744 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8745 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8746 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8747 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8748 tcp-request content reject
8749
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087517.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8752--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008753
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008754A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008755application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8756read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8757than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8758
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008759base <string>
8760 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8761 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8762 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8763 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8764 See also "path" and "uri".
8765
8766base_beg <string>
8767 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8768 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8769 "path_beg".
8770
8771base_dir <string>
8772 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8773 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8774 "path_dir" instead.
8775
8776base_dom <string>
8777 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8778 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8779 instead.
8780
8781base_end <string>
8782 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8783 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8784
8785base_len <integer>
8786 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8787 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8788
8789base_reg <regex>
8790 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8791 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8792 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8793 and all "base_" criteria.
8794
8795base_sub <string>
8796 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8797 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8798 also "base_dir".
8799
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008800cook(<name>) <string>
8801 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8802 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8803 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8804 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8805 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8806 sent by the server.
8807
8808 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8809 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8810 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8811
8812 cook(profile) silver gold
8813
8814cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8815 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8816 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8817 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8818
8819cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8820 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8821 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8822 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8823 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8824 server.
8825
8826cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8827 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8828 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8829 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8830 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8831 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8832
8833cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8834 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8835 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8836 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8837 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8838
8839cook_end(<name>) <string>
8840 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8841 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8842 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8843
8844cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8845 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8846 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8847 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8848 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8849 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8850
8851cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8852 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8853 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8854 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8855 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8856 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8857
8858cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8859 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8860 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8861 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8862
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008863cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8864 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8865 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8866 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8867 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8868 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8869
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008870hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008871hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008872 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8873 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8874 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8875 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008876 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8877 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8878 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8879 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8880 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008881
8882 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008883 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008884 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8885
8886 hdr(Connection) -i close
8887
8888hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008889hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008890 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8891 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8892 response headers sent by the server.
8893
8894hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008895hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8897 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8898 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8899 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8900 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8901 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8902 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8903
8904hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008905hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008906 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8907 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8908 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8909 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8910 headers sent by the server.
8911
8912hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008913hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8915 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8916 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8917 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8918 server.
8919
8920hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008921hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008922 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8923 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8924 response headers sent by the server.
8925
8926hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008927hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8928 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8929 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8930 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008931 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8932
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008933hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008934hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008935 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8936 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8937 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8938 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8939
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008941hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008942 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008943 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8944 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8945 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8946 response headers sent by the server.
8947
8948hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008949hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8951 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8952 response headers sent by the server.
8953
8954hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008955hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008956 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8957 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8958 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8959 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8960
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008961http_auth(<userlist>)
8962http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008963 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8964 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8965 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8966 of specified groups.
8967
8968 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8969
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008970http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008971 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8972 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8973 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8974 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008976method <string>
8977 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8978 already check for most common methods.
8979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008980path <string>
8981 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8982 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8983 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8984
8985path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008986 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8987 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008988
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008989path_dir <string>
8990 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8991 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8992 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8993 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8994
8995path_dom <string>
8996 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8997 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8998 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8999
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009000path_end <string>
9001 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9002 control file name extension.
9003
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009004path_len <integer>
9005 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9006 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9007
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009008path_reg <regex>
9009 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9010 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9011 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9012
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009013path_sub <string>
9014 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9015 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9016 "path_dir".
9017
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009018payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9019 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9020 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9021 strings.
9022
9023payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9024 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9025 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9026 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9027 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9028 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9029
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009030req_ver <string>
9031 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9032 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9033
9034status <integer>
9035 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9036 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9037 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009039url <string>
9040 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009041 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009042
9043url_beg <string>
9044 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009045 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9046 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009048url_dir <string>
9049 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9050 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9051 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9052 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9053
9054url_dom <string>
9055 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9056 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9057 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9058
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009059url_end <string>
9060 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9061 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009062
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009063url_ip <address>
9064 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9065 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9066 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009067
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009068url_len <integer>
9069 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9070 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9071
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009072url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009073 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9074 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009075 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009076 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009077
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009078url_reg <regex>
9079 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9080 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009081 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009082
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009083url_sub <string>
9084 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9085 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009086
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009087urlp(<name>) <string>
9088 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9089 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9090
9091 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9092 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9093
9094urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9095 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9096 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9097 protocol scheme.
9098
9099urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9100 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9101 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9102 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9103 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9104
9105urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9106 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9107 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9108 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9109 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9110
9111urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9112 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9113
9114urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009115 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9116 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009117
9118urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9119 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9120 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9121
9122urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9123 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9124 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9125 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9126 "urlp_" criteria.
9127
9128urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9129 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9130 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9131 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9132
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009133urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9134 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9135 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9136 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9137 negative data.
9138
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091407.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9141---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009143Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9144every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009145order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009147ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9148---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009149FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009150HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009151HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9152HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009153HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9154HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9155HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9156HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9157LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009158METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9159METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9160METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9161METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9162METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9163METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009164RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009165REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009166TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009167WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9168---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009169
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091717.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9172----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009174Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9175combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009177 - AND (implicit)
9178 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9179 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009181A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009183 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009185Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9186indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009188For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9189"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9190requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9191is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009193 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9194 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9195 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9196 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009198To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9199and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009201 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9202 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9203 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9204 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009206 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9207 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9208 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9209 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009210
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009211It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9212expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9213be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009214the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009215
9216 The following rule :
9217
9218 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9219 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9220
9221 Can also be written that way :
9222
9223 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9224
9225It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9226to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9227simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9228sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9229good use is the following :
9230
9231 With named ACLs :
9232
9233 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9234 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9235 monitor fail if site_dead
9236
9237 With anonymous ACLs :
9238
9239 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009241See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009242
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009243
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010092447.8. Pattern extraction
9245-----------------------
9246
9247The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9248response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9249for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9250
9251All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9252"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9253begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9254arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9255much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9256equivalent used in ACLs.
9257
9258The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9259
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009260 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9261 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9262 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9263 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9264 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9265 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9266 requested objects by host/path.
9267
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009268 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009269 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9270 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9271 according to RFC 4291.
9272
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009273 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9274 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9275 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009276 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9277 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9278 according to RFC 4291.
9279
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009280 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9281 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9282 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9283 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9284 type integer and only works with such tables.
9285
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009286 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9287 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9288 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9289 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9290 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9291 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9292 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009293 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009294
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009295 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9296 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9297 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9298 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9299 wiser to use "url" instead.
9300
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009301 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009302 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9303 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9304 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9305 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009306
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009307 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009308 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9309 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9310 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9311 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9312 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9313 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9314 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9315 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009316
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009317 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9318 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9319 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9320 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9321
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009322 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9323 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9324
9325 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9326 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9327 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9328
9329 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9330 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9331
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009332 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9333 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9334 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9335 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9336 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9337 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9338 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9339 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9340 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9341 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9342 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9343
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009344 ssl_c_key_alg
9345 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9346 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9347 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9348
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009349 ssl_c_notafter
9350 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9351 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9352 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9353
9354 ssl_c_notbefore
9355 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9356 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9357 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9358
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009359 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9360 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9361 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9362 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9363 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9364 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9365 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9366 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9367 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9368 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9369 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9370
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009371 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9372 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9373 layer.
9374
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009375 ssl_c_sig_alg
9376 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9377 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9378 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9379
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009380 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9381 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9382 error is encountered.
9383
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009384 ssl_c_version
9385 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9386 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9387 layer.
9388
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009389 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9390 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9391 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9392 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9393 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9394 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9395 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9396 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9397 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9398 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9399 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9400
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009401 ssl_f_key_alg
9402 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9403 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9404 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9405
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009406 ssl_f_notafter
9407 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9408 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9409 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9410
9411 ssl_f_notbefore
9412 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9413 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9414 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9415
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009416 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9417 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9418 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9419 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9420 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9421 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9422 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9423 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9424 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9425 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9426 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9427
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009428 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9429 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9430 layer.
9431
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009432 ssl_f_sig_alg
9433 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9434 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9435 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9436
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009437 ssl_f_version
9438 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9439 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9440 layer.
9441
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009442 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9443 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9444 otherwise zero.
9445
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009446 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9447 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9448 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9449
9450 ssl_fc_cipher
9451 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9452 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9453
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009454 ssl_fc_has_crt
9455 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9456 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9457
9458 ssl_fc_has_sni
9459 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009460 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9461 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009462 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009463 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009464
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009465 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009466 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9467 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9468 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9469 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009470 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009471
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009472 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009473 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9474 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009475
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009476 ssl_fc_session_id
9477 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9478 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9479 stick on a given client.
9480
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009481 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009482 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9483 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9484 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9485 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9486 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009487
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009488 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9489 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9490 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9491
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009492 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9493 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9494 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9495 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9496
9497 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9498 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9499 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9500 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9501 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9502 table for a given source address.
9503
9504 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9505 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9506
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009507 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009508 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009509 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9510 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9511 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9512 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9513 where cookies cannot be used.
9514
9515 Example :
9516 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9517 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9518 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9519 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009520
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009521 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009522 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9523 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9524 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9525 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009526
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009527 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9528 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9529 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9530 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9531 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9532 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9533 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009534
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009535 Example :
9536 listen tse-farm
9537 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9538 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9539 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9540 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9541 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9542 persist rdp-cookie
9543 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9544 # This is only useful makes sense if
9545 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9546 stick-table type string size 204800
9547 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9548 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9549 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009550
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009551 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9552 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009553
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009554 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009555 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009556 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9557 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9558 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9559 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9560 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9561 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009562
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009563 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009564
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009565 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009566 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9567 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9568 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9569
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009570 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9571 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9572 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9573 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9574 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009576 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009577
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009578
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009579The currently available list of transformations include :
9580
9581 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9582 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9583 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9584
9585 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9586 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9587 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9588
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009589 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009590 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9591 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9592 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9593 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9594
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095968. Logging
9597----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009598
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009599One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9600provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9601very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9602provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9603state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009604to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009605headers.
9606
9607In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9608about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9609send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9610
9611 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9612 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9613 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9614 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9615 at the termination.
9616
9617The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9618allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9619as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9620while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9621real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9622delay.
9623
9624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096258.1. Log levels
9626---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009627
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009628TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009629source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009630HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9631in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9632track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9633syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9634about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009635
9636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096378.2. Log formats
9638----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009639
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009640HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009641and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9642slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9643options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009644
9645 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9646 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9647 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9648 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9649 extents.
9650
9651 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9652 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9653 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9654 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9655 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9656
9657 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9658 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9659 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9660 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9661 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9662
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009663 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9664 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9665 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9666 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9667
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009668 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009670Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9671specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9672field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9673servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9674always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9675identifier.
9676
9677Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9678 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9679 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9680 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9681 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9682
9683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096848.2.1. Default log format
9685-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009686
9687This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9688as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9689format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9690
9691 Example :
9692 listen www
9693 mode http
9694 log global
9695 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9696
9697 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9698 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9699 (www/HTTP)
9700
9701 Field Format Extract from the example above
9702 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9703 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9704 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9705 4 'to' to
9706 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9707 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9708
9709Detailed fields description :
9710 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9711 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9712 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9713 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9714 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9715 and processed the connection.
9716 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9717
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009718In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9719"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9720connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9721
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009722It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9723will eventually disappear.
9724
9725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097268.2.2. TCP log format
9727---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009728
9729The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9730is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9731information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9732counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9733emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9734environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9735the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9736sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009737specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9738not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9739fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9740marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009741
9742 Example :
9743 frontend fnt
9744 mode tcp
9745 option tcplog
9746 log global
9747 default_backend bck
9748
9749 backend bck
9750 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9751
9752 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9753 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9754 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9755
9756 Field Format Extract from the example above
9757 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9758 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9759 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9760 4 frontend_name fnt
9761 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9762 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9763 7 bytes_read* 212
9764 8 termination_state --
9765 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9766 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9767
9768Detailed fields description :
9769 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009770 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9771 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9772 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9773 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9774 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009775
9776 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009777 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9778 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9779 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009780
9781 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9782 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9783 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9784 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9785
9786 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9787 and processed the connection.
9788
9789 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9790 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9791 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9792 applications.
9793
9794 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9795 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9796 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9797 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9798 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9799
9800 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9801 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9802 See "Timers" below for more details.
9803
9804 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9805 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9806 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9807 "Timers" below for more details.
9808
9809 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9810 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9811 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9812 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9813 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9814 details.
9815
9816 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9817 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9818 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9819 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9820 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9821
9822 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9823 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9824 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9825 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9826 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9827 for more details.
9828
9829 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009830 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009831 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9832 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9833 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009834 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009835
9836 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9837 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9838 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9839 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9840 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9841 caused by a denial of service attack.
9842
9843 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9844 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9845 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9846 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9847 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9848 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9849 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9850 denial of service attack.
9851
9852 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9853 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9854 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9855 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9856 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9857 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9858 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9859 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9860 be processed than on other servers.
9861
9862 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9863 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9864 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9865 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9866 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9867 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9868 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9869 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9870 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9871 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9872 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9873 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9874 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9875
9876 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9877 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9878 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9879 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9880 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9881 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9882 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9883 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9884
9885 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9886 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9887 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9888 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9889 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9890 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9891 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9892 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9893 occurs.
9894
9895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098968.2.3. HTTP log format
9897----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009898
9899The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9900is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9901the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9902are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9903emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9904generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9905"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9906which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009907frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9908is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009909
9910Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9911slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9912with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9913
9914 Example :
9915 frontend http-in
9916 mode http
9917 option httplog
9918 log global
9919 default_backend bck
9920
9921 backend static
9922 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9923
9924 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9925 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9926 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009927 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009928
9929 Field Format Extract from the example above
9930 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9931 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9932 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9933 4 frontend_name http-in
9934 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9935 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9936 7 status_code 200
9937 8 bytes_read* 2750
9938 9 captured_request_cookie -
9939 10 captured_response_cookie -
9940 11 termination_state ----
9941 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9942 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9943 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9944 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9945 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009946
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009947
9948Detailed fields description :
9949 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009950 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9951 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9952 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9953 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9954 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009955
9956 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009957 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9958 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9959 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009960
9961 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9962 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9963 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9964 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9965 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9966
9967 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9968 and processed the connection.
9969
9970 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9971 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9972 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9973
9974 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9975 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9976 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9977 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9978 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9979 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9980
9981 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9982 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9983 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9984 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9985 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9986 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9987
9988 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9989 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9990 See "Timers" below for more details.
9991
9992 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9993 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9994 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9995 below for more details.
9996
9997 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9998 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9999 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10000 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10001 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10002 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10003 for more details.
10004
10005 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10006 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10007 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10008 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10009 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10010 details.
10011
10012 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10013 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10014 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10015
10016 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10017 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10018 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10019 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10020 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10021 overflowing.
10022
10023 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10024 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10025 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10026 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10027 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10028 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10029 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10030 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10031
10032 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10033 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10034 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10035 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10036 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10037 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10038 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10039 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10040
10041 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10042 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10043 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10044 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10045 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10046 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10047 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10048
10049 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010050 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010051 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10052 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10053 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010054 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010055 system.
10056
10057 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10058 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10059 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10060 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10061 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10062 caused by a denial of service attack.
10063
10064 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10065 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10066 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10067 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10068 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10069 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10070 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10071 denial of service attack.
10072
10073 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10074 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10075 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10076 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10077 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10078 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10079 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10080 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10081 processed than on other servers.
10082
10083 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10084 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10085 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10086 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10087 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10088 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10089 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10090 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10091 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10092 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10093 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10094 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10095 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10096
10097 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10098 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10099 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10100 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10101 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10102 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10103 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10104 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10105
10106 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10107 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10108 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10109 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10110 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10111 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10112 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10113 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10114 occurs.
10115
10116 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10117 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10118 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10119 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10120 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10121 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10122 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10123 cookies" below for more details.
10124
10125 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10126 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10127 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10128 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10129 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10130 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10131 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10132 and cookies" below for more details.
10133
10134 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10135 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10136 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10137 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10138 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10139 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10140 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10141 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10142
10143
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200101448.2.4. Custom log format
10145------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010146
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010147The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10148mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010149
10150HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10151Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10152separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10153prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10154
10155Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10156variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10157string formats ("Q").
10158
10159Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10160HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10161
10162Flags are :
10163 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010164 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010165
10166 Example:
10167
10168 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10169 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10170
10171At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10172
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010173 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010174 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010175
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010176the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010177
10178 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010179 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010180 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10181
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010182and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10183
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010184 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010185 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010187Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10188
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010189 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010190 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010191 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10192 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10193 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10194 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010195 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010196 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010197 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010198 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010199 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10200 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10201 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010202 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010203 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10204 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10205 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010206 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010207 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010208 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10209 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010210 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010211 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10212 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10213 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10214 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10215 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10216 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010217 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10218 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10219 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010220 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010221 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010222 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010223 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10224 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10225 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10226 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010227 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010228 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010229 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010230 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10231 | | %s | server_name | string |
10232 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10233 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010234 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10235 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10236 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010237 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010238 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010239 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010240 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010241
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010242 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010243
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010244
102458.2.5. Error log format
10246-----------------------
10247
10248When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10249protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10250By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10251"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10252will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10253logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10254
10255The format looks like this :
10256
10257 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10258 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10259 Connection error during SSL handshake
10260
10261 Field Format Extract from the example above
10262 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10263 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10264 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10265 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10266 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10267
10268These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10269failures.
10270
10271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102728.3. Advanced logging options
10273-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010274
10275Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10276just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10277options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10278for more information about their usage.
10279
10280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10282------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010283
10284It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10285haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10286commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10287monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10288ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10289
10290 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10291 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10292 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10293 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10294
10295 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10296 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10297 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10298 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10299 such as other load-balancers.
10300
10301 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10302 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10303 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10304
10305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10307----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010308
10309The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10310what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10311or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10312"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10313just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10314log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10315after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10316is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10317with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10318with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10319
10320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103218.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10322------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010323
10324Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10325for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10326"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10327retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10328raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10329a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10330file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10331you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10332"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10333
10334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103358.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10336--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010337
10338Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10339multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10340them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10341"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10342logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10343error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10344and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10345too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10346useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10347alternative.
10348
10349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103508.4. Timing events
10351------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010352
10353Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10354reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10355the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10356frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10357mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10358
10359 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10360 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10361 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10362 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10363 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10364
10365 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10366 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10367 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10368 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10369 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10370
10371 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10372 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10373 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10374 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10375 connection never established.
10376
10377 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10378 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10379 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10380 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10381 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10382 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10383 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10384 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10385 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10386 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10387 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10388
10389 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10390 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10391 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10392 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10393 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10394
10395 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10396
10397 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10398 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10399 negative.
10400
10401These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10402protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10403that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010404due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010405close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10406session has been aborted on timeout.
10407
10408Most common cases :
10409
10410 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10411 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10412 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10413 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10414 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10415 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10416 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10417 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10418 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010419 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10420 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10421 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010422
10423 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10424 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10425 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10426 of ms on remote networks.
10427
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010428 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10429 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10430 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010431
10432 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10433 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10434 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10435 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10436 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10437 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10438 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10439 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10440 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10441 to the server until another one is released.
10442
10443Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10444
10445 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10446 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10447 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10448
10449 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10450 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10451 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10452
10453 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10454 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10455 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10456 flags.
10457
10458 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10459 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10460 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10461 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10462 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10463 the client connection was maintained open.
10464
10465 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10466 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10467 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10468 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10469
10470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104718.5. Session state at disconnection
10472-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010473
10474TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10475"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
104762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10477each of which has a special meaning :
10478
10479 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10480 session to terminate :
10481
10482 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10483
10484 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10485 server explicitly refused it.
10486
10487 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10488 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10489 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10490 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10491 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10492 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10493
10494 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10495 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10496 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10497 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10498 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10499
10500 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10501 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10502 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10503 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10504 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10505
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010506 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10507 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10508
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010509 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10510 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10511 backup connections when going up.
10512
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010513 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10514
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010515 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10516 send or receive data.
10517
10518 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10519 send or receive data.
10520
10521 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10522 with nothing left in the buffers.
10523
10524 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10525
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010526 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010527 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10528
10529 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10530 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10531 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10532 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10533 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10534
10535 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10536 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10537
10538 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10539 server (HTTP only).
10540
10541 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10542
10543 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10544 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10545 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10546
10547 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10548 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10549 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10550
10551 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10552
10553 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10554 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10555
10556 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10557 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10558 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10559
10560 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10561 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010562 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10563 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010564
10565 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10566 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10567 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10568 another server.
10569
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010570 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010571 server.
10572
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010573 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10574 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10575 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10576 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10577
10578 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10579 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10580 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10581 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10582
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010583 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10584 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10585 "use-server" rule).
10586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010587 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10588
10589 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10590 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10591
10592 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10593
10594 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10595 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10596 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10597
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010598 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10599 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10600 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10601 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10602 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10603
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010604 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10605
10606 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10607 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10608
10609 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10610
10611 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10612
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010613The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10614was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010615helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10616starvation, attacks, etc...
10617
10618The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10619alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10620easier finding and understanding.
10621
10622 Flags Reason
10623
10624 -- Normal termination.
10625
10626 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10627 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10628 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10629 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10630
10631 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10632 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10633 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10634 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10635 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10636 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010637
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010638 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10639 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010640 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010641
10642 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10643 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10644 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10645
10646 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10647 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10648 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10649 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10650 the server takes too long to respond.
10651
10652 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10653 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10654 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10655 long a time to respond.
10656
10657 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10658 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10659 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10660 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10661 and the client.
10662
10663 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10664 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10665 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10666 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10667 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10668 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10669
10670 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10671 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010672 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10673 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10674 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10675 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010677 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010678 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10679 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10680 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10681 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10682 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10683
10684 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10685 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10686 503 or 504 here.
10687
10688 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10689 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10690 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10691 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10692 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10693
10694 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10695 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010696 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010697 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10698 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10699
10700 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10701 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10702 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10703 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10704 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10705 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10706 between haproxy and the server.
10707
10708 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10709 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10710 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10711 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10712 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10713 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10714 solution is to fix the application.
10715
10716 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10717 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10718 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10719 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10720 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10721 external attacks.
10722
10723 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10724 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010725 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010726 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10727 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10728
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010729 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10730 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10731 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10732 the client.
10733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010734 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10735 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10736 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10737 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010738 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10739 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10740 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10741 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10742 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010743
10744 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10745 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10746 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10747 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10748
10749 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10750 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10751 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10752 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10753
10754 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10755 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10756 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10757 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10758
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010759The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10760persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10761important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10762re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10763
10764 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10765
10766 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10767 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10768 set on a GET request.
10769
10770 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10771 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010772 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010773 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10774
10775 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10776 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10777 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10778
10779 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10780 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10781 already got a cookie.
10782
10783 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10784 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10785 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10786 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10787 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10788
10789 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10790 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10791 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10792
10793 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10794 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10795 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10796
10797 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10798 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10799
10800 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10801 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10802 then advertised in the response.
10803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108058.6. Non-printable characters
10806-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010807
10808In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10809consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10810converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10811prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10812being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10813escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10814is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10815'}' when logging headers.
10816
10817Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10818issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10819containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10820
10821Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10822the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10823performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10824
10825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108268.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10827---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010828
10829Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10830achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010831section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010832cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10833the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10834the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010835locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010836not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10837user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10838a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10839wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10840
10841 Examples :
10842 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10843 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10844
10845 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10846 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10847
10848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108498.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10850---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010851
10852Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10853proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10854the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10855server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10856
10857Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10858response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010859section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010860
10861It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010862time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10863appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010864are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10865and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10866follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10867request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10868in the logs.
10869
10870 Example :
10871 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10872 listen proxy-out
10873 mode http
10874 option httplog
10875 option logasap
10876 log global
10877 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10878
10879 # log the name of the virtual server
10880 capture request header Host len 20
10881
10882 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10883 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10884
10885 # log the beginning of the referrer
10886 capture request header Referer len 20
10887
10888 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10889 capture response header Server len 20
10890
10891 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10892 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10893
10894 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10895 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10896
10897 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10898 capture response header Via len 20
10899
10900 # log the URL location during a redirection
10901 capture response header Location len 20
10902
10903 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10904 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10905 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10906 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10907 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10908
10909 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10910 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10911 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10912 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010913 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010914
10915 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10916 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10917 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10918 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10919 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010920 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010921
10922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109238.9. Examples of logs
10924---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010925
10926These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10927them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10928reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10929
10930 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10931 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10932 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10933
10934 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10935 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10936
10937 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10938 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10939 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10940
10941 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10942 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10943
10944 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10945 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10946 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10947
10948 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010949 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010950 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10951 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10952
10953 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10954 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10955 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10956
10957 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10958 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010959 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010960 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10961 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10962 to return the 502 and not the server.
10963
10964 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010965 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010966
10967 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10968 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10969 Nothing was sent to any server.
10970
10971 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10972 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10973
10974 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10975 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10976 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10977 send a 408 return code to the client.
10978
10979 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10980 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10981
10982 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10983 5 seconds ("c----").
10984
10985 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10986 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010987 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010988
10989 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010990 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010991 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10992 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10993 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10994 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10995 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010996
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109989. Statistics and monitoring
10999----------------------------
11000
11001It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11002mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11003CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11004Unix socket.
11005
11006
110079.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011008---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011009
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011010The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11011page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011013 0. pxname: proxy name
11014 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11015 for server)
11016 2. qcur: current queued requests
11017 3. qmax: max queued requests
11018 4. scur: current sessions
11019 5. smax: max sessions
11020 6. slim: sessions limit
11021 7. stot: total sessions
11022 8. bin: bytes in
11023 9. bout: bytes out
11024 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011025 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011026 12. ereq: request errors
11027 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011028 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011029 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11030 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011031 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011032 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11033 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11034 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11035 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11036 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11037 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11038 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11039 25. qlimit: queue limit
11040 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11041 27. iid: unique proxy id
11042 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11043 29. throttle: warm up status
11044 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11045 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011046 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011047 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11048 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11049 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011050 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011051 UNK -> unknown
11052 INI -> initializing
11053 SOCKERR -> socket error
11054 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11055 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11056 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11057 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11058 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11059 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11060 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11061 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11062 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11063 disable-on-404
11064 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11065 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11066 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011067 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11068 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011069 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11070 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11071 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11072 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11073 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11074 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011075 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11076 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11077 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11078 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011079 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11080 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011081 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11082 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11083 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011084 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011085
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110879.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011088-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011089
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011090The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011091must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11092is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11093a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11094risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11095followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11096given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11097then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11098to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011099
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011100It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11101on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11102own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011104clear counters
11105 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11106 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11107 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11108 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11109 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11110
11111clear counters all
11112 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11113 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11114 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11115
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011116clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11117 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11118
11119 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11120 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11121 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11122 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11123 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11124 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11125
11126 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11127
11128 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11129 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11130 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11131 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11132 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11133 the ACLs :
11134
11135 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11136 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11137 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11138 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11139 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11140 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11141
11142 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011143 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11144 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011145
11146 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011147 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011148 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011149 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11150 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11151 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11152 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011153
11154 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11155
11156 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011157 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011158 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11159 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011160 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11161 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11162 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011163
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011164disable frontend <frontend>
11165 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11166 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11167 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11168 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11169 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11170 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11171 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11172 on the stats page.
11173
11174 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11175 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11176
11177 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11178 level "admin".
11179
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011180disable server <backend>/<server>
11181 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11182 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11183 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11184 during the maintenance.
11185
11186 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11187 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11188
11189 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011190 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011191
11192 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11193 level "admin".
11194
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011195enable frontend <frontend>
11196 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11197 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11198 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11199 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11200 which was disabled.
11201
11202 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11203 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11204
11205 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11206 level "admin".
11207
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011208enable server <backend>/<server>
11209 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11210 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11211
11212 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011213 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011214
11215 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11216 level "admin".
11217
11218get weight <backend>/<server>
11219 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11220 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11221 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11222 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11223 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011224 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011225
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011226help
11227 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11228 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011229
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011230prompt
11231 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11232 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11233 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11234 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11235 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11236 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11237 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11238 command.
11239
11240quit
11241 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011242
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011243set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011244 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11245 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11246 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11247 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11248 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011249 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11250 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11251
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011252set maxconn global <maxconn>
11253 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11254 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11255 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11256 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11257 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11258 setting.
11259
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011260set rate-limit connections global <value>
11261 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11262 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11263 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11264 is passed in number of connections per second.
11265
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011266set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11267 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11268 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011269 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11270 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011271
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011272set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11273 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11274 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11275 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11276 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11277 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011279set timeout cli <delay>
11280 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11281 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11282 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11283
11284set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11285 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11286 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11287 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11288 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11289 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11290 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11291 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11292 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11293 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11294 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11295 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11296 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11297 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011298 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011299
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011300show errors [<iid>]
11301 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11302 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011303 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11304 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11305 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011306
11307 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11308 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11309 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11310 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11311 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11312 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11313 are reported too.
11314
11315 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11316 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11317 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11318 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11319 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11320 code.
11321
11322 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11323 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11324 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11325 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11326 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11327 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11328 line.
11329
11330 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011331 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11332 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011333 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11334 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11335
11336 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11337 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11338 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11339 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11340 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11341 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11342 00204+ minal\r\n
11343 00211 \r\n
11344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011345 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011346 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11347 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11348 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11349 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11350 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11351 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011352
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011353show info
11354 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11355
11356show sess
11357 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011358 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11359 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11360
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011361show sess <id>
11362 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11363 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11364 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11365 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11366 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011367 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11368 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11369 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011370
11371show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11372 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11373 possible to dump only selected items :
11374 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11375 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11376 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11377 for example:
11378 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11379 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11380 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11381
11382 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011383 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11384 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011385 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11386 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11387 Nbproc: 1
11388 Process_num: 1
11389 (...)
11390
11391 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11392 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11393 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11394 (...)
11395 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11396
11397 $
11398
11399 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11400 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11401 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11402 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011403 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011404
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011405show table
11406 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11407 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11408 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11409 entries currently in use.
11410
11411 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011412 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011413 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11414 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011415
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011416show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011417 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11418 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11419 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011420 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11421
11422 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11423 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11424 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11425 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11426 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11427
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011428 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11429 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11430 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11431 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11432 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11433 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11434
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011435
11436 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011437 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11438 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011439
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011440 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011441 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011442 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011443 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11444 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11445 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11446 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011447
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011448 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011449 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011450 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11451 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011452
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011453 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11454 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011455 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011456 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11457 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011458
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011459 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11460 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011461 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011462 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11463 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11464
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011465 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11466 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11467 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11468 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11469 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11470
11471 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11472 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11473 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011474 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11475 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011476 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11477 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011478
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011479shutdown frontend <frontend>
11480 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11481 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11482 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11483 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11484 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11485 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11486 once it is terminated.
11487
11488 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11489 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11490
11491 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11492 level "admin".
11493
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011494shutdown session <id>
11495 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11496 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11497 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11498 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11499 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11500 flag in the logs.
11501
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011502shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11503 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11504 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11505 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11506 'K' flag in the logs.
11507
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011508/*
11509 * Local variables:
11510 * fill-column: 79
11511 * End:
11512 */